blob: 3b76b01e299a59fc922fc329129cc57b8ef41f4a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200568log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100593 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594
595 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
596 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
597 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
598
599 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200600 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
601 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
602 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
603 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
604 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
605 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200607 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609log-send-hostname [<string>]
610 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
611 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
612 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
613 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
614 the logs.
615
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000616log-tag <string>
617 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
618 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
619 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
620 running on the same host.
621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200622nbproc <number>
623 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
624 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
625 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
626 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
627 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
628
629pidfile <pidfile>
630 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
631 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
632 starting the process. See also "daemon".
633
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200635 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
636 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
637 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
638 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
639 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
640 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100641 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200642 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
643 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200644
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100645ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
647 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300648 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100649 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
650 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
651 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
652 "bind" keyword for more information.
653
654ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
656 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300657 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100658 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
659 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
660 information.
661
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100662ssl-server-verify [none|required]
663 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
664 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
665 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
666
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200667stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
668 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
669 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
670 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
671 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200672
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200673 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
674 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
675 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200676
677stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
678 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
679 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100680 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200681
682stats maxconn <connections>
683 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
684 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
685
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200686uid <number>
687 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
688 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
689 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
690 one. See also "gid" and "user".
691
692ulimit-n <number>
693 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
694 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
695 option.
696
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100697unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
698 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
699
700 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
701 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
702 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
703 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
704 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
705 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
706 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
707 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
708 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
709 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
710
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711user <user name>
712 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
713 See also "uid" and "group".
714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200715node <name>
716 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
717
718 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
719 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
720 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
721 traffic.
722
723description <text>
724 Add a text that describes the instance.
725
726 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
727 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
728 "<" and ">" characters.
729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007313.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200732-----------------------
733
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200734max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
735 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
736 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
737 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
738 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
739 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
740 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
741 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
742 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
743
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744maxconn <number>
745 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
746 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
747 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200748 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
749 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
750 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
751 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
752 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200753
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200754maxconnrate <number>
755 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
756 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
757 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
758 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
759 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
760 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
761 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
762 fairness.
763
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100764maxcomprate <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300766 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100767 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
768 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
769 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
770 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
771 default value.
772
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100773maxcompcpuusage <number>
774 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
775 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
776 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
777 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
778 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
779 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
780 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
781 process down and from introducing high latencies.
782
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100783maxpipes <number>
784 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
785 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
786 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
787 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
788 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
789 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
790
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200791maxsessrate <number>
792 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
793 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
794 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
795 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
796 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
797 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
798 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
799 fairness.
800
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200801maxsslconn <number>
802 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
803 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
804 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
805 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
806 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
807 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
808 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
809
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200810maxsslrate <number>
811 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
812 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
813 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
814 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
815 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
816 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
817 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
818 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
819 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
820 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
821
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100822maxzlibmem <number>
823 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
824 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
825 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100826 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
827 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
828 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200830noepoll
831 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
832 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
835nokqueue
836 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
837 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
838 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
839
840nopoll
841 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
842 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100843 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100844 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100846nosplice
847 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
848 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
849 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100850 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100851 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
852 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
853 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
854 "option splice-response".
855
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300856nogetaddrinfo
857 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
858 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
859
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200860spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900861 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
862 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
863 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
864 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
865 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
866 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200867
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200868tune.bufsize <number>
869 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
870 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
871 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
872 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
873 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
874 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
875 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
876 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400877 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
878 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
879 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200880
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200881tune.chksize <number>
882 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
883 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
884 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
885 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
886 checks whenever possible.
887
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100888tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
889 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
890 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
891 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
892 this value. The default value is 1.
893
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100894tune.http.cookielen <number>
895 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
896 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
897 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
898 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
899 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
900 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
901 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
902 to change this value.
903
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200904tune.http.maxhdr <number>
905 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
906 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
907 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
908 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
909 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
910 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
911 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
912 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
913 limit too high.
914
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915tune.idletimer <timeout>
916 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
917 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
918 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
919 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
920 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
921 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
922 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
923 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
924 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
925
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100927 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
928 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
929 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
930 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
931 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
932 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
933 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
934 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
935 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
936 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100937
938tune.maxpollevents <number>
939 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
940 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
941 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
942 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
943 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
944
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200945tune.maxrewrite <number>
946 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
947 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
948 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
949 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
950 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
951 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
952 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
953 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
954 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
955 bufsize.
956
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200957tune.pipesize <number>
958 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
959 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
960 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
961 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
962 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
963 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
964
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100965tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
966tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
967 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
968 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
969 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
970 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
971 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
972 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
973 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
974
975tune.sndbuf.client <number>
976tune.sndbuf.server <number>
977 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
978 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
979 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
980 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
981 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
982 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
983 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
984 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
985 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
986 notifying haproxy again.
987
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100988tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100989 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
990 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
991 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300992 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100993 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
994 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
995 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
996 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
997 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100998 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
999 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001000
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001001tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1002 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1003 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1004 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1005 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1006 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1007 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1008
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001009tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1010 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001011 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001012 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1013 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1014 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1015 being used for too long.
1016
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1018 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1019 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1020 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1021 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1022 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1023 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1024 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1025 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1026 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1027 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001028 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1029 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001030
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001031tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1032 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1033 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1034 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1035 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1036 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1037 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1038 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1039 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1040
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001041tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1042 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001043 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001044 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1045 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1046 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1047
1048tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1049 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1050 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1051 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1052 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010543.3. Debugging
1055--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
1057debug
1058 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1059 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1060 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1061 system startup.
1062
1063quiet
1064 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1065 line argument "-q".
1066
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010683.4. Userlists
1069--------------
1070It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1071http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1072it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1073
1074userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001075 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1077
1078group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001079 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1081 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001083user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1084 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001085 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1086 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001087 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1088 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001089 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001090 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001091
1092
1093 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001094 userlist L1
1095 group G1 users tiger,scott
1096 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001098 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1099 user scott insecure-password elgato
1100 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001101
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001102 userlist L2
1103 group G1
1104 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001106 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1107 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1108 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109
1110 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001112
11133.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001114----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001115It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1116haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1117pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1118identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1119or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1120Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1121known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1122the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1123process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1124during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1125tables.
1126
1127peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001128 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001129 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1130
1131peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1132 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1133 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1134 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1135 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1136 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1137 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1138
1139 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1140 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1141
1142 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1143 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1144 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1145 across all peers.
1146
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001147 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1148 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1149 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001151 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001152 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001153 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1154 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1155 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001156
1157 backend mybackend
1158 mode tcp
1159 balance roundrobin
1160 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1161 stick on src
1162
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001163 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1164 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001165
1166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001168----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001170Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1171 - defaults <name>
1172 - frontend <name>
1173 - backend <name>
1174 - listen <name>
1175
1176A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1177its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1178section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001179section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180
1181A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1182connections.
1183
1184A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1185to forward incoming connections.
1186
1187A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1188parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1189
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001190All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1191'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1192case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1193
1194Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1195logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1196proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1197However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1198name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1199
1200Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1201and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001202bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001203protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1204modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1205arbitrary criteria.
1206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001207In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1208a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1209the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1210
1211 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1212 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1213 between responses and new requests.
1214
1215 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1216 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1217 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1218 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1219
1220 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1221 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1222 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1223
1224 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1225 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1226 client-facing connection remains open.
1227
1228 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1229 after the end of the response.
1230
1231The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1232frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1233following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1234weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1235
1236 Backend mode
1237
1238 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1239 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1240 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1241 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1242 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1243 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1244 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1245 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1246 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1247 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1248 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1253--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001255The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1256limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1257they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1258limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001260option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001261and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1262with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1263specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001266 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1267------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1268acl - X X X
1269appsession - - X X
1270backlog X X X -
1271balance X - X X
1272bind - X X -
1273bind-process X X X X
1274block - X X X
1275capture cookie - X X -
1276capture request header - X X -
1277capture response header - X X -
1278clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001279compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001280contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1281cookie X - X X
1282default-server X - X X
1283default_backend X X X -
1284description - X X X
1285disabled X X X X
1286dispatch - - X X
1287enabled X X X X
1288errorfile X X X X
1289errorloc X X X X
1290errorloc302 X X X X
1291-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1292errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001293force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001294fullconn X - X X
1295grace X X X X
1296hash-type X - X X
1297http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001298http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001299http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001301http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001302http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001303id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001304ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001305log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001306max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001307maxconn X X X -
1308mode X X X X
1309monitor fail - X X -
1310monitor-net X X X -
1311monitor-uri X X X -
1312option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1313option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1314option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1315option allbackups (*) X - X X
1316option checkcache (*) X - X X
1317option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1318option contstats (*) X X X -
1319option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1320option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1321option forceclose (*) X X X X
1322-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1323option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001324option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001325option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001326option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001327option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001328option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001329option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1330option httpchk X - X X
1331option httpclose (*) X X X X
1332option httplog X X X X
1333option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001334option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001335option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001337option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1338option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1339option logasap (*) X X X -
1340option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001341option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001342option nolinger (*) X X X X
1343option originalto X X X X
1344option persist (*) X - X X
1345option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001346option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001347option smtpchk X - X X
1348option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1349option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1350option splice-request (*) X X X X
1351option splice-response (*) X X X X
1352option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1353option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1354-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001355option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001356option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1357option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1358option tcpka X X X X
1359option tcplog X X X X
1360option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001361external-check command X - X X
1362external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1364rate-limit sessions X X X -
1365redirect - X X X
1366redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1367redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1368reqadd - X X X
1369reqallow - X X X
1370reqdel - X X X
1371reqdeny - X X X
1372reqiallow - X X X
1373reqidel - X X X
1374reqideny - X X X
1375reqipass - X X X
1376reqirep - X X X
1377reqisetbe - X X X
1378reqitarpit - X X X
1379reqpass - X X X
1380reqrep - X X X
1381-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1382reqsetbe - X X X
1383reqtarpit - X X X
1384retries X - X X
1385rspadd - X X X
1386rspdel - X X X
1387rspdeny - X X X
1388rspidel - X X X
1389rspideny - X X X
1390rspirep - X X X
1391rsprep - X X X
1392server - - X X
1393source X - X X
1394srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001395stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001396stats auth X - X X
1397stats enable X - X X
1398stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001399stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001400stats realm X - X X
1401stats refresh X - X X
1402stats scope X - X X
1403stats show-desc X - X X
1404stats show-legends X - X X
1405stats show-node X - X X
1406stats uri X - X X
1407-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1408stick match - - X X
1409stick on - - X X
1410stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001411stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001413tcp-check connect - - X X
1414tcp-check expect - - X X
1415tcp-check send - - X X
1416tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001417tcp-request connection - X X -
1418tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001419tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001420tcp-response content - - X X
1421tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001422timeout check X - X X
1423timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001424timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1426timeout connect X - X X
1427timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1428timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1429timeout http-request X X X X
1430timeout queue X - X X
1431timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001432timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001433timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1434timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001435timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001436transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001437unique-id-format X X X -
1438unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001439use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001440use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001441------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1442 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014454.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1446---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001447
1448This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1449
1450
1451acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1452 Declare or complete an access list.
1453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1454 no | yes | yes | yes
1455 Example:
1456 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1457 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1458 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001460 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001461
1462
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1464 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1467 no | no | yes | yes
1468 Arguments :
1469 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1470 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1471
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001472 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473 checked in each cookie value.
1474
1475 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1476 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1477 milliseconds.
1478
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001479 request-learn
1480 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1481 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1482 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1483 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1484 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1485 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1486
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001487 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1488 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1489 data following this prefix.
1490
1491 Example :
1492 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1493
1494 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1495 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1496
1497 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1498 2 modes are currently supported :
1499 - path-parameters :
1500 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1501 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1502 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1503 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1504 - query-string :
1505 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1506 query string.
1507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1509 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1510 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1511 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001512 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1513 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1514 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001515 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1516 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1517
1518 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1519
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001520 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1521 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1522 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001524 Example :
1525 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1526
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001527 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1528 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001529
1530
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001531backlog <conns>
1532 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1534 yes | yes | yes | no
1535 Arguments :
1536 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1537 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001538 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001539
1540 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1541 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1542 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1543 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1544 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1545 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1546 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1547 backlog parameter.
1548
1549 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1550 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1551 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1552
1553 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1554
1555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001557balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1560 yes | no | yes | yes
1561 Arguments :
1562 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1563 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1564 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1565 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1566
1567 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1568 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1569 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1570 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001571 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001572 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001573 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1574 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1575 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1576 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1577 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1578 it, so that you don't worry.
1579
1580 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1581 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1582 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1583 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1584 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1585 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1586 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1587 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001589 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1590 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1591 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1592 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1593 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1594 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1595 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1596 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1597
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001598 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001599 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001600 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1601 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001602 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001603 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1604 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1605 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1606 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1607 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001608 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1609 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1610 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1611 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1612 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1613 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1616 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1617 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1618 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1619 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1620 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1621 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1622 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001625 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1626 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1627 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001629 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1630 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1631 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1632 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1633 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1634 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1635 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1636 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1637 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1638 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1639 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1640 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001642 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001643 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1644 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1645 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1646 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1647 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1648 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1649 URIs start with a leading "/".
1650
1651 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1652 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1653 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1654 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1655
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001657 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1658
1659 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001660 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1661 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001662 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1663 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1664 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1665 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001666 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001667 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1668 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001669
1670 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1671 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1672 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1673 server will receive the request.
1674
1675 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1676 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1677 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1678 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1679 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001680 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1681 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1682 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001683
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1685 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1686 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1687 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1688 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001690 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001691 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1692 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1693 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1694
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001695 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1696 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1697 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1698
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001699 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001700 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001701 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1702 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1703 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1704 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1705 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1706 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001707 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001708 used instead.
1709
1710 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1711 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1712 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1713 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1714
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001715 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1716 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1717 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1718
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001719 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001722 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1723 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001724
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001725 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1726 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1727 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001728
1729 Examples :
1730 balance roundrobin
1731 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001732 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001733 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1734 balance hdr(host)
1735 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001736
1737 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1738 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1742 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1743 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1744 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1745
1746 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1747 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1748 defaults to 16 kB.
1749
1750 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1751 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1752
1753 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1754 Round Robin.
1755
1756 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1757 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1758 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1759 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1760
1761 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1762
1763 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001764 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001765 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1766 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1767 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001769 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1770 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001771
1772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001773bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1774bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001775 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1777 no | yes | yes | no
1778 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001779 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1780 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1781 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1782 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001783 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001784 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1785 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1786 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1787 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1788 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1789 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1790 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001791 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001792 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1793 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1794 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001795 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1796 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1797 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1798 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001799
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001800 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1801 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001802 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1803 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1804 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001805 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1806 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1807 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1808 the range.
1809
1810 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1811 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1812 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1813 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1814 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1815 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1816 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001817 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001818 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1821 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1822 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1823 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1824 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1825 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1826 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1827 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001829 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1830 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1831 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1832 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1835 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1836 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1837 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1838 in a frontend.
1839
1840 Example :
1841 listen http_proxy
1842 bind :80,:443
1843 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001846 listen http_https_proxy
1847 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001848 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001849
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001850 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1851 bind ipv6@:80
1852 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1853 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1854
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001855 listen external_bind_app1
1856 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1857
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001858 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001859 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001860
1861
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001862bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001863 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1865 yes | yes | yes | yes
1866 Arguments :
1867 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1868 may be used to override a default value.
1869
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001870 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871 option may be combined with other numbers.
1872
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001873 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001874 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1875 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1876 missing from all processes.
1877
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001878 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001879 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001880 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1881 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1882 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1883 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001884
1885 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1886 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1887 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1888 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1889 and 'even' instances.
1890
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001891 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1892 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1893 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1894 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001896 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1897 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1898
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001899 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1900 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1901
1902 Example :
1903 listen app_ip1
1904 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001905 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001906
1907 listen app_ip2
1908 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001909 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001910
1911 listen management
1912 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001913 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001914
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001915 listen management
1916 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1917 bind-process 1-4
1918
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001919 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001920
1921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922block { if | unless } <condition>
1923 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1925 no | yes | yes | yes
1926
1927 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1928 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001929 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001930 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1932 "block" statements per instance.
1933
1934 Example:
1935 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1936 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1937 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1938 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001940 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001941
1942
1943capture cookie <name> len <length>
1944 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1946 no | yes | yes | no
1947 Arguments :
1948 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1949 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1950 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1951 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1952 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1953
1954 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1955 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1956 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1957 right if it exceeds <length>.
1958
1959 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1960 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1961 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1962 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1963
1964 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1965 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1966 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1967
1968 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1969 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1970 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001971 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1972 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1973 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974
1975 Example:
1976 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1977
1978 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001979 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980
1981
1982capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001983 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1985 no | yes | yes | no
1986 Arguments :
1987 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001988 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001989 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1990 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1991 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1992
1993 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1994 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1995 it exceeds <length>.
1996
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001997 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1999 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002000 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2001 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2002 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2003 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002004 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002005 environments to find where the request came from.
2006
2007 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2008 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2009 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2010 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002012 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2013 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2014 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2015 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2016 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018 Example:
2019 capture request header Host len 15
2020 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2021 capture request header Referrer len 15
2022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002023 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024 about logging.
2025
2026
2027capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002028 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2030 no | yes | yes | no
2031 Arguments :
2032 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002033 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2035 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2036 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2037
2038 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2039 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2040 it exceeds <length>.
2041
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002042 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2044 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2045 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002046 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2047 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2048 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2049 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002051 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2052 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2053 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2054 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2055 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056
2057 Example:
2058 capture response header Content-length len 9
2059 capture response header Location len 15
2060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002061 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 about logging.
2063
2064
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002065clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2068 yes | yes | yes | no
2069 Arguments :
2070 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2071 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2072 as explained at the top of this document.
2073
2074 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2075 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2076 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2077 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2078 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2079 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2080 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2081 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002082 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2084 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2085
2086 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2087 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2088 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2089 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2090 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2091 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2092
2093 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2094 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2095
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002096 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2097 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002099compression algo <algorithm> ...
2100compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002101compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002102 Enable HTTP compression.
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | yes
2105 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002106 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2107 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2108 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2109
2110 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002111 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002112 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2113 data.
2114
2115 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2116 support for zlib was built in.
2117
2118 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2119 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2120 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2121 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2122 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2123 in.
2124
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002125 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002126 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002127 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2128 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2129 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2130 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2131 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002132
2133 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2134 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2135 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2136 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2137 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002138 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2139 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2140 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2141 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2142 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2143 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002144
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002145 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002146 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2147 "Accept-Encoding" header
2148 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002149 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002150 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2151 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002152 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2153 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2154 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2155 "multipart"
2156 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2157 header
2158 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2159 and later
2160 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2161 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002162
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002163 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2164 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002165
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002166 Examples :
2167 compression algo gzip
2168 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002170contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2173 yes | no | yes | yes
2174 Arguments :
2175 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2176 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2177 as explained at the top of this document.
2178
2179 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002180 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002181 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2183 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2184 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2185 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2186
2187 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2188 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2189 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2190 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2191 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2192 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2193
2194 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2195 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2196 instead.
2197
2198 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2199 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2200
2201
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002202cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002203 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2204 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2207 yes | no | yes | yes
2208 Arguments :
2209 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2210 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2211 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2212 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2213 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2214 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2215 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2216 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2217 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2218
2219 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2220 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2221 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2222 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2223 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2224 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2225 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2226 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2227 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2228 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2229 "insert" and "prefix".
2230
2231 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002232 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002233
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002234 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002235 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2236 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2237 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2238 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2239 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2240 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2241 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2242 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2243 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2244 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
2246 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2247 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2248 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2249 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2250 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2251 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2252 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2253 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2254 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2255 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002256 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2257 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2258 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002260 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2261 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2262 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002263 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2264 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2265 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2266 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002267 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2268 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2269 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270
2271 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2272 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2273 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2274 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2275 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2276 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2277 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2278 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2279 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2280
2281 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2282 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2283 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2284 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2285 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2286 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2287 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2288 persistence cookie in the cache.
2289 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2290
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002291 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2292 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2293 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2294 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2295 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2296 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2297 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2298 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2299 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2300 they logout.
2301
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002302 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2303 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2304 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2305 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2306
2307 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2308 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2309 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2310 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2311 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2312 this attribute.
2313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002314 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002315 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002316 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2317 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2318 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2319 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2320 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2321 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002322
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002323 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2324 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2325 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2326 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2327 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2328 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2329 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2330 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2331 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2332 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2333 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2334 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2335 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2336 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2337 the site.
2338
2339 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2340 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2341 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2342 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2343 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2344 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2345 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2346 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2347 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2348 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2349 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2350 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2351 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2352 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2353 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2354 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2357 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2358 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2359 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361 Examples :
2362 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2363 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2364 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002365 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002367 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002368 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002371default-server [param*]
2372 Change default options for a server in a backend
2373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2374 yes | no | yes | yes
2375 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002376 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2377 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2378 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2379 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002380
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002381 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002382 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2383
2384 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387default_backend <backend>
2388 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 yes | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2393
2394 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2395 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2396 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2397 will catch all undetermined requests.
2398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399 Example :
2400
2401 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2402 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2403 default_backend dynamic
2404
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002405 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002408description <string>
2409 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2411 no | yes | yes | yes
2412 Arguments : string
2413
2414 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2415 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2416 it describes.
2417 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2418
2419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420disabled
2421 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2423 yes | yes | yes | yes
2424 Arguments : none
2425
2426 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2427 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2428 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2429 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2430 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2431 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2432 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2433
2434 See also : "enabled"
2435
2436
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002437dispatch <address>:<port>
2438 Set a default server address
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002441 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002442
2443 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2444 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2445 during start-up.
2446
2447 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2448 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2449 possible with normal servers.
2450
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002451 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002452 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2453 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2454 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2455 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2456
2457 See also : "server"
2458
2459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460enabled
2461 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | yes | yes | yes
2464 Arguments : none
2465
2466 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2467 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2468
2469 See also : "disabled"
2470
2471
2472errorfile <code> <file>
2473 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2475 yes | yes | yes | yes
2476 Arguments :
2477 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002478 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479
2480 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002481 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002482 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002483 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2484 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485
2486 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2487 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2488 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2489
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002490 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2493 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2494 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2495 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2496
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002497 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2498 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2499 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2500 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2501 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2502 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2505 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2506 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002507 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2509
2510 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2511
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 Example :
2513 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002514 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002515 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2516 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2517
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002518
2519errorloc <code> <url>
2520errorloc302 <code> <url>
2521 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2523 yes | yes | yes | yes
2524 Arguments :
2525 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002526 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002527
2528 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2529 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2530 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2531 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2532 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2533
2534 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2535 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2536 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2537
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002538 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2539
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002540 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2541 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2542 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2543 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2544 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2545 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2546 request.
2547
2548 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2549
2550
2551errorloc303 <code> <url>
2552 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2554 yes | yes | yes | yes
2555 Arguments :
2556 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2557 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2558
2559 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2560 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2561 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2562 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2563 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2564
2565 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2566 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2567 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2568
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002569 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2570
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2572 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2573 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2574 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002575 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2578
2579
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002580force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2581 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 no | yes | yes | yes
2584
2585 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2586 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2587 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2588 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2589 marked down for maintenance operations.
2590
2591 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2592 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2593 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2594 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2595 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2596 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2597 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2598 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2599 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2600
2601 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2602 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2603 is used.
2604
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002605 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002606 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002607
2608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609fullconn <conns>
2610 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | no | yes | yes
2613 Arguments :
2614 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2615 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2616
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002617 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002618 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002619 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002620 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2621 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2622 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2623 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2624 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002625 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002626
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002627 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2628 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002629 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2630 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2631 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002632
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 Example :
2634 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2635 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2636 # connections.
2637 backend dynamic
2638 fullconn 10000
2639 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2640 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2641
2642 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2643
2644
2645grace <time>
2646 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 Arguments :
2650 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2651 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2652 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2653
2654 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2655 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002656 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2658
2659 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2660 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2661 simplify it.
2662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002664hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002665 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2667 yes | no | yes | yes
2668 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002669 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2670 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002671
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002672 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2673 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2674 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2675 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2676 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2677 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2678 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2679 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2680 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2681 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002682
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002683 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2684 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2685 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2686 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2687 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2688 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2689 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2690 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2691 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2692 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2693 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2694 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2695 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002696 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2697 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698
2699 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2700
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002701 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002702 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2703 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2704 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002705 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2706 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2707 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002708
2709 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2710 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002711 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2712 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2713 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2714 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2715
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002716 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2717 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2718 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2719 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2720 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2721 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2722 parameter.
2723
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002724 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2725
2726 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2727 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2728 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2729 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2730 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2731 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2732 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2733 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2734 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2735 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2736 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2737 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002738
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002739 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2740 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2741 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002742
2743 See also : "balance", "server"
2744
2745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746http-check disable-on-404
2747 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750 Arguments : none
2751
2752 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2753 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2754 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2755 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2756 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2757 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2758 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2759 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002760 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2761 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2762 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2763
2764 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2765
2766
2767http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002768 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002770 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002771 Arguments :
2772 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2773 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002774 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002775 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2776 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2777 details on the supported keywords.
2778
2779 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2780 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2781 with the usual backslash ('\').
2782
2783 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2784 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2785 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2786 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2787 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2788
2789 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002790 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002791 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2792 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2793 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2794
2795 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002796 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002797 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2798 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2799 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2800 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2801
2802 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2805 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2806 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2807 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2808 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2809 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2810 trace).
2811
2812 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002813 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002814 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2815 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2816 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2817 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2818 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2819 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2820
2821 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2822 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2823 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2824 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2825 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2826 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2827 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2828 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2829
2830 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2831 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2832
2833 Examples :
2834 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002835 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002836
2837 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002838 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002839
2840 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002841 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002842
2843 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002844 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002846 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002847
2848
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002849http-check send-state
2850 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2852 yes | no | yes | yes
2853 Arguments : none
2854
2855 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2856 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2857 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2858 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2859 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2860
2861 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2862 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2863 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2864 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2865 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2866 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2867 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2868 checked in multiple backends.
2869
2870 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2871 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2872
2873 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2874 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2875 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2876 one fails.
2877
2878 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2879 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2880 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2881
2882 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2883 server's queue.
2884
2885 Example of a header received by the application server :
2886 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2887 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2888
2889 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2890
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002891http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002892 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002893 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002894 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2895 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002896 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2897 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2898 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2899 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2900 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2901 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002903 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2904
2905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2906 no | yes | yes | yes
2907
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002908 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2909 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2910 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2911 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2912 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002914 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2915 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2916 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2917
2918 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2919 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2920 are evaluated.
2921
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002922 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2923 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2924 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2925 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2926 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2927 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2928 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2929 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2930 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002931 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002932 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002934 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2935 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2936 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2937 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2938 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2939
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002940 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2941 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2942 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002943 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2944 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002945
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002946 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2947 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2948 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2949 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2950 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2951 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2952 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2953 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2954
2955 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2956 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2957 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2958 external users.
2959
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002960 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2961 <name>.
2962
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002963 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2964 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2965 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2966 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2967 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2968 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2969 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2970 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2971
2972 Example:
2973
2974 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2975
2976 applied to:
2977
2978 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2979
2980 outputs:
2981
2982 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2983
2984 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
2985
2986 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
2987 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
2988 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
2989 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
2990 header.
2991
2992 Example:
2993
2994 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
2995
2996 applied to:
2997
2998 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
2999
3000 outputs:
3001
3002 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3003
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003004 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3005 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3006 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3007 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3008 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3009 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3010 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3011 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3012
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003013 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3014 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3015 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3016 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3017 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3018 another equipment.
3019
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003020 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3021 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3022 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3023 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3024 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3025 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3026 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3027 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3028
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003029 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3030 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3031 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3032 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3033 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3034 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3035 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3036 admin privileges.
3037
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003038 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3039 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3040 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3041 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3042 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3043 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3044 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3045 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3046
3047 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3048 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3049 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3050 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3051 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3052 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3053
3054 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3055 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3056 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3057 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3058 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3059 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3060
3061 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3062 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3063 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3064 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3065 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3066 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3067 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3068 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3069 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3070
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003071 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3072
3073 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3074 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3075 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3076 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003077
3078 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003079 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3080 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3081 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003082
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003083 http-request allow if nagios
3084 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3085 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3086 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003087
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003088 Example:
3089 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003090 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003091
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003092 Example:
3093 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3094 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3095 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3096 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3097 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3098 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3099 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3100 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3101 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3102
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003103 Example:
3104 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3105 acl add path /addacl
3106 acl del path /delacl
3107
3108 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3109
3110 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3111 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3112
3113 Example:
3114 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3115 acl setmap path /setmap
3116 acl delmap path /delmap
3117
3118 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3119
3120 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3121 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3122
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003123 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3124 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003125
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003126http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003127 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003128 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3129 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003130 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3131 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3132 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3133 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3134 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3135 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003136 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003137 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3138
3139 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 no | yes | yes | yes
3141
3142 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3143 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3144 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3145 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3146 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3147 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3148
3149 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3150 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3151 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3152 current section.
3153
3154 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3155 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3156 rules are evaluated.
3157
3158 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3159 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3160 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3161 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3162 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3163 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3164 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3165
3166 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3167 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3168 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3169 external users.
3170
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003171 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3172 <name>.
3173
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003174 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3175 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3176 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3177 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3178 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3179 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3180 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3181 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3182
3183 Example:
3184
3185 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3186
3187 applied to:
3188
3189 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3190
3191 outputs:
3192
3193 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3194
3195 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3196
3197 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3198 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3199 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3200 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3201 header.
3202
3203 Example:
3204
3205 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3206
3207 applied to:
3208
3209 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3210
3211 outputs:
3212
3213 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3214
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003215 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3216 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3217 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3218 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3219 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3220 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3221 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3222 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3223
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003224 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3225 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3226 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3227 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3228 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3229 another equipment.
3230
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003231 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3232 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3233 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3234 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3235 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3236 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3237 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3238 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3239
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003240 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3241 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3242 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3243 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3244 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3245 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3246 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3247 admin privileges.
3248
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003249 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3250 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3251 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3252 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3253 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3254 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3255 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3256 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3257
3258 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3259 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3260 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3261 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3262 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3263 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3264
3265 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3266 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3267 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3268 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3269 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3270 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3271
3272 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3273 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3274 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3275 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3276 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3277 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3278 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3279 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3280 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3281
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003282 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3283
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003284 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003285 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3286 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3287 rules.
3288
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003289 Example:
3290 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3291
3292 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3293
3294 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3295 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3296
3297 Example:
3298 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3299
3300 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3301
3302 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3303 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3304
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003305 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3306 ACL usage.
3307
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003308
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003309http-send-name-header [<header>]
3310 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3311
3312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | no | yes | yes
3314
3315 Arguments :
3316
3317 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3318
3319 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3320 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3321 is added with the header string proved.
3322
3323 See also : "server"
3324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003325id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003326 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3328 no | yes | yes | yes
3329 Arguments : none
3330
3331 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3332 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3333 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003334
3335
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003336ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3337 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3339 no | yes | yes | yes
3340
3341 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3342 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3343 and running).
3344
3345 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3346 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3347 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003348 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003349 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3350
3351 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3352 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3353
3354 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3355 "unless" condition is met.
3356
3357 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3358
3359
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003361log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003362no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003363 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3365 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003366
3367 Prefix :
3368 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3369 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3370 prefix does not allow arguments.
3371
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003372 Arguments :
3373 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3374 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3375 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3376 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3377 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3378 parameter.
3379
3380 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3381 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3382
3383 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3384 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3385 standard syslog port).
3386
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003387 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3388 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3389 standard syslog port).
3390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003391 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3392 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3393 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3394 appropriately writeable).
3395
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003396 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3397 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3398 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3399 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003401 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3402
3403 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3404 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3405 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3406
3407 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3408 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3409 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003410 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3411 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3412 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3413 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3414 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003415
3416 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3417
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003418 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3419 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3420 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003421
3422 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3423 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3424 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3425 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3426
3427 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3428 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003429
3430 Example :
3431 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003432 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3433 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003434 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3435
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003436
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003437log-format <string>
3438 Allows you to custom a log line.
3439
3440 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003442
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003443max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3444 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3445 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | no | yes | yes
3447
3448 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3449 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3450 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3451 servers.
3452
3453 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3454 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3455 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3456 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3457 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3458 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3459 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3460 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3461 picking a different server.
3462
3463 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3464 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3465 even if they have to be queued.
3466
3467 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3468 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3469
3470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003471maxconn <conns>
3472 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3474 yes | yes | yes | no
3475 Arguments :
3476 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3477 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3478 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3479 closes.
3480
3481 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3482 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3483 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3484 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3485 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3486 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3487 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3488 properly tuned.
3489
3490 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3491 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3492 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3493
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003494 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3495
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3497
3498
3499mode { tcp|http|health }
3500 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | yes | yes | yes
3503 Arguments :
3504 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3505 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3506 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3507 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3508
3509 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3510 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3511 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3512 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3513 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3514
3515 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003516 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3517 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3518 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3519 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3520 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3521 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3522 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003524 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3525 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3526 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003527
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003528 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003529 defaults http_instances
3530 mode http
3531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003532 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003534
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003535monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003536 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539 Arguments :
3540 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3541 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003542 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003543 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3544 backend and its backup.
3545
3546 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3547 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3548 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3549 servers in a list of backends.
3550
3551 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3552 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3553 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3554 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3555 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3556 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3557 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003558 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3559 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003560
3561 Example:
3562 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003563 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3565 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3566 monitor-uri /site_alive
3567 monitor fail if site_dead
3568
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003569 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003570
3571
3572monitor-net <source>
3573 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3575 yes | yes | yes | no
3576 Arguments :
3577 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3578 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3579 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3580 followed by a mask.
3581
3582 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3583 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003584 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3586
3587 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3588 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3589 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3590 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003591 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3592 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3593 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003594
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003595 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3596 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3597 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3598 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3599 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3600 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003602 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3603 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605 Example :
3606 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3607 frontend www
3608 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3609
3610 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3611
3612
3613monitor-uri <uri>
3614 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | no
3617 Arguments :
3618 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3619 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3620
3621 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3622 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3623 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3624 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3625 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3626 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3627 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3628 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3629
3630 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3631 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3632 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3633 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3634 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3635 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3636
3637 Example :
3638 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3639 frontend www
3640 mode http
3641 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3642
3643 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003645
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003646option abortonclose
3647no option abortonclose
3648 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3650 yes | no | yes | yes
3651 Arguments : none
3652
3653 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3654 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3655 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3656 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003657 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003658 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3659 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3660 encountered while delivering the response.
3661
3662 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3663 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3664 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3665 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3666 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3667 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003668 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003669 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003670 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003671 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3672 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3673 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3674
3675 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3676 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3677 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3678 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3679 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3680 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3681 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3682 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003683 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003684
3685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3687
3688 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3689
3690
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003691option accept-invalid-http-request
3692no option accept-invalid-http-request
3693 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3695 yes | yes | yes | no
3696 Arguments : none
3697
3698 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3699 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3700 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3701 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3702 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3703 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3704 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3705 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003706 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3707 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3708 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3709 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3710 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3711 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003712
3713 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3714 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3715 been confirmed.
3716
3717 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3718 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003719 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3720 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003721 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3722
3723 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3724 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3725
3726 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3727 stats socket.
3728
3729
3730option accept-invalid-http-response
3731no option accept-invalid-http-response
3732 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3734 yes | no | yes | yes
3735 Arguments : none
3736
3737 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3738 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3739 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3740 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3741 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3742 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3743 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3744 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3745 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3746
3747 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3748 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3749 been confirmed.
3750
3751 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3752 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3753 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3754 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3755
3756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3758
3759 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3760 stats socket.
3761
3762
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003763option allbackups
3764no option allbackups
3765 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3767 yes | no | yes | yes
3768 Arguments : none
3769
3770 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3771 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3772 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3773 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3774 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3775 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3776 order between the backup servers anymore.
3777
3778 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3779 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3780
3781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3783
3784
3785option checkcache
3786no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003787 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | no | yes | yes
3790 Arguments : none
3791
3792 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3793 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003794 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003795 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3796 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003797 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003798
3799 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003800 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003801 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003802 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3803 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003804 to the client are :
3805 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003806 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003807 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003808 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3809 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3810 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3811 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3812 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3813 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3814 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3815 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3816 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3817 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3818 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3819
3820 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003821 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003822 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003823 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003824 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3825
3826 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3827 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003828 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003829 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3830
3831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3833
3834
3835option clitcpka
3836no option clitcpka
3837 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | no
3840 Arguments : none
3841
3842 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3843 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3844 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3845 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3846
3847 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3848 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3849 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3850 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3851
3852 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3853 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3854 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3855 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3856 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3857
3858 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3859
3860 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3861 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3862 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3863
3864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3866
3867 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3868
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870option contstats
3871 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3873 yes | yes | yes | no
3874 Arguments : none
3875
3876 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3877 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3878 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3879 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3880 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3881 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3882 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3883
3884
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003885option dontlog-normal
3886no option dontlog-normal
3887 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3889 yes | yes | yes | no
3890 Arguments : none
3891
3892 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3893 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3894 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3895 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3896 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3897 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3898 logged.
3899
3900 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3901 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3902 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003904 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003905 logging.
3906
3907
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003908option dontlognull
3909no option dontlognull
3910 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 yes | yes | yes | no
3913 Arguments : none
3914
3915 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3916 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3917 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3918 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3919 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3920 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3921 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3922
3923 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3924 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3925 would not be logged.
3926
3927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003930 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003931
3932
3933option forceclose
3934no option forceclose
3935 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003937 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003938 Arguments : none
3939
3940 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3941 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3942 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3943 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3944 global session times in the logs.
3945
3946 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003947 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003948 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003949
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003950 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3951 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3952 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3953
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003954 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3955 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003956
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3959
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003960 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003961
3962
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003963option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003964 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | yes | yes | yes
3967 Arguments :
3968 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3969 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003970 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003971 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003972
3973 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3974 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3975 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3976 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3977 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3978 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3979 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003980 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3981 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3982 possible that the client has already brought one.
3983
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003984 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003985 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003986 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3987 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003988 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3989 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003990
3991 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3992 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3993 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3994 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3995 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3996 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3997 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3998
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003999 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4000 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4001 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4002 are under the control of the end-user.
4003
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004004 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004005 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4006 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004007 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4008 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4009 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004010
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004011 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004012 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4013 frontend www
4014 mode http
4015 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4016
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004017 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4018 backend www
4019 mode http
4020 option forwardfor header X-Client
4021
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004022 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004023 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004024
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004025
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004026option http-keep-alive
4027no option http-keep-alive
4028 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | yes | yes | yes
4031 Arguments : none
4032
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004033 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4034 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4035 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4036 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4037 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4038 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4039 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4040
4041 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4042 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004043 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4044 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4045 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4046 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4047 situations where this option may be useful :
4048
4049 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4050 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4051
4052 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4053 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4054
4055 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4056 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4057 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4058 request.
4059
4060 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4061 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004062 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4063 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4064 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004065
4066 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4067 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4068
4069 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4070 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4071 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4072 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4073 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4074 not set.
4075
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004076 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4077 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004078 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004079 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004080
4081 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004082 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4083 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004084
4085
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004086option http-no-delay
4087no option http-no-delay
4088 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4090 yes | yes | yes | yes
4091 Arguments : none
4092
4093 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4094 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4095 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4096 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4097 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4098 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4099 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4100 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4101 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4102 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4103 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4104 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4105 affected.
4106
4107 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4108 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4109 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4110 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4111 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4112 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4113 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4114 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4115 latency environments.
4116
4117
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004118option http-pretend-keepalive
4119no option http-pretend-keepalive
4120 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 yes | yes | yes | yes
4123 Arguments : none
4124
4125 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4126 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4127 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4128 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4129 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4130 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4131 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4132 consider the response complete.
4133
4134 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4135 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4136 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4137 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4138 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4139 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4140
4141 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4142 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4143 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4144 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4145 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4146 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4147 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4148
4149 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4150 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004151 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004152 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4153 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004154
4155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4157
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004158 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4159 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004160
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004161
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004162option http-server-close
4163no option http-server-close
4164 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4166 yes | yes | yes | yes
4167 Arguments : none
4168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004169 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4170 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4171 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4172 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4173 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4174 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4175 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4176 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4177 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4178 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4179 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4180 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4181 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4182 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4183 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4184 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004185
4186 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4187 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4188 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4189 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004190 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4191 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004192
4193 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4194 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004195 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4196 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004197 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4198 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004199
4200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4202
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004203 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004204 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4205 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004206
4207
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004208option http-tunnel
4209no option http-tunnel
4210 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | yes | yes | yes
4213 Arguments : none
4214
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004215 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4216 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4217 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4218 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4219 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4220 "option http-tunnel".
4221
4222 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004223 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004224 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4225 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4226 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4227 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4228 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4229 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4230 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004231
4232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4234
4235 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4236 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4237 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4238
4239
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004240option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004241no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004242 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 yes | yes | yes | no
4245 Arguments : none
4246
4247 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4248 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4249 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4250 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4251 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4252 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4253 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4254
4255 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4256 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4257 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4258 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4259 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4260 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4261 request along its whole life.
4262
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004263 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4264 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4265 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4266 front of an existing proxy.
4267
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004268 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4269
4270 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4271 http-server-close".
4272
4273
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004274option httpchk
4275option httpchk <uri>
4276option httpchk <method> <uri>
4277option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4278 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4280 yes | no | yes | yes
4281 Arguments :
4282 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4283 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4284 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4285 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4286 ones.
4287
4288 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4289 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4290 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4291
4292 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4293 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4294 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4295 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4296 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4297
4298 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4299 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4300 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4301 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4302 the lack of any response.
4303
4304 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4305
4306 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4307 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4308 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4309
4310 Examples :
4311 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4312 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4313 backend https_relay
4314 mode tcp
4315 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4316 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4317
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004318 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4319 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4320 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004321
4322
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004323option httpclose
4324no option httpclose
4325 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 yes | yes | yes | yes
4328 Arguments : none
4329
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004330 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4331 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4332 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4333 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004334 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004335 "option http-tunnel".
4336
4337 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4338 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4339 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4340 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4341 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4342 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4343 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4344 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004345
4346 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004347 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004348 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4349 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4350 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4351 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4352 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004353
4354 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4355 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004356 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4357 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004358 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4359 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004360
4361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4363
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004364 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4365 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004366
4367
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004368option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004369 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004372 Arguments :
4373 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4374 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4375 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4376 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4377 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004378
4379 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4380 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4381 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4382 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4383 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4384 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4385 ports.
4386
4387 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4388
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004389 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4390 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4391 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4392 by default.
4393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004394 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004395
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004396
4397option http_proxy
4398no option http_proxy
4399 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 yes | yes | yes | yes
4402 Arguments : none
4403
4404 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4405 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4406 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4407 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4408 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4409
4410 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4411 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4412 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4413 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004414 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004415 be analyzed.
4416
4417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4419
4420 Example :
4421 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4422 backend direct_forward
4423 option httpclose
4424 option http_proxy
4425
4426 See also : "option httpclose"
4427
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004428
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004429option independent-streams
4430no option independent-streams
4431 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | yes | yes | yes
4434 Arguments : none
4435
4436 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4437 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4438 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4439 receive data or not.
4440
4441 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4442 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4443 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4444 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4445 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4446 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4447 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4448 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4449 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4450 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4451 socket buffers.
4452
4453 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4454 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4455 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4456 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4457 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4458
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004459 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004460 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4461 deprecated.
4462
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004463 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004464
4465
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004466option ldap-check
4467 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4469 yes | no | yes | yes
4470 Arguments : none
4471
4472 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4473 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4474 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4475 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4476
4477 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4478 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4479
4480 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4481 configure it.
4482
4483 Example :
4484 option ldap-check
4485
4486 See also : "option httpchk"
4487
4488
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004489option external-check
4490 Use external processes for server health checks
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493
4494 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4495 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4496 command".
4497
4498 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4499
4500 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4501
4502
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004503option log-health-checks
4504no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004505 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 yes | no | yes | yes
4508 Arguments : none
4509
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004510 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4511 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4512 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004513
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004514 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4515 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4516 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4517 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4518 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4519
4520 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4521 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004522
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004523 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4524 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4525 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004526
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004527
4528option log-separate-errors
4529no option log-separate-errors
4530 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4532 yes | yes | yes | no
4533 Arguments : none
4534
4535 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4536 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4537 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4538 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4539 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4540 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4541 provides very important information.
4542
4543 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4544 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4545 error logs.
4546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004547 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004548 logging.
4549
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004550
4551option logasap
4552no option logasap
4553 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 yes | yes | yes | no
4556 Arguments : none
4557
4558 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4559 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4560 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4561 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4562 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4563 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4564 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004565 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004566 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4567 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4568
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004569 Examples :
4570 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4571 mode http
4572 option httplog
4573 option logasap
4574 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4575
4576 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4577 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4578 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4579 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004581 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004582 logging.
4583
4584
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004585option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004586 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4588 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004589 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004590 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4591 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004592 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004593
4594 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4595 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4596 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4597 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4598 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4599 in the MySQL table, like this :
4600
4601 USE mysql;
4602 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4603 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4604
4605 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4606 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4607 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4608 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4609 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4610 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4611 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4612 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4613 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4614
4615 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4616 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004617
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004618 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004619
4620 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4621 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4622 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4623 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4624 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4625 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4626
4627 See also: "option httpchk"
4628
4629
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004630option nolinger
4631no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004632 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004635 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004636
4637 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4638 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4639 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4640 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4641 connections.
4642
4643 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4644 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4645 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4646 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4647 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4648 this too.
4649
4650 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4651 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4652 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4653
4654 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4655 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4656 for servers.
4657
4658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4660
4661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004662option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4663 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | yes | yes | yes
4666 Arguments :
4667 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4668 matching <network>
4669 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4670 header name.
4671
4672 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4673 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4674 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4675 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4676 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4677 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4678 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4679 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4680 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4681 possible that the client has already brought one.
4682
4683 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4684 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4685 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4686 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4687 header and requires different one.
4688
4689 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4690 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4691 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4692 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4693 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4694 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4695 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4696
4697 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4698 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4699 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4700 both are defined.
4701
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004702 Examples :
4703 # Original Destination address
4704 frontend www
4705 mode http
4706 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4707
4708 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4709 backend www
4710 mode http
4711 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4712
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004713 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4714 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004715
4716
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004717option persist
4718no option persist
4719 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004722 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004723
4724 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4725 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4726 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4727 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4728 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4729 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4730 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4731 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4732 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4733 redirected to another valid server.
4734
4735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4737
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004738 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004739
4740
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004741option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4742 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 yes | no | yes | yes
4745 Arguments :
4746 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4747 PostgreSQL server.
4748
4749 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4750 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4751 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4752 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4753
4754 See also: "option httpchk"
4755
4756
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004757option prefer-last-server
4758no option prefer-last-server
4759 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | no | yes | yes
4762 Arguments : none
4763
4764 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4765 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4766 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4767 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4768 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4769 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4770 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4771 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4772 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004773 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4774 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4775 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4776 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4777 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4778 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4779 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004780
4781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4783
4784 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4785
4786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004787option redispatch
4788no option redispatch
4789 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004792 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004793
4794 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4795 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4796 be able to access the service anymore.
4797
4798 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4799 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4800
4801 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4802 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4803 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004805 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4806 "redisp" keywords.
4807
4808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4810
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004811 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004812
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004813
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004814option redis-check
4815 Use redis health checks for server testing
4816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4817 yes | no | yes | yes
4818 Arguments : none
4819
4820 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4821 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4822 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4823 find the "+PONG" response message.
4824
4825 Example :
4826 option redis-check
4827
4828 See also : "option httpchk"
4829
4830
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004831option smtpchk
4832option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4833 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004836 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004837 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4838 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4839 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4840
4841 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4842 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4843 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4844
4845 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4846 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4847 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4848 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4849 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4850 dead server.
4851
4852 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4853 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4854 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4855 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4856
4857 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4858 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4859 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4860 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4861 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4862
4863 Example :
4864 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4865
4866 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004869option socket-stats
4870no option socket-stats
4871
4872 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4874 yes | yes | yes | no
4875
4876 Arguments : none
4877
4878
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004879option splice-auto
4880no option splice-auto
4881 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments : none
4885
4886 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4887 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4888 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4889 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004890 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004891 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4892 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4893 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4894 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4895
4896 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4897 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4898 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4899 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4900 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4901 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4902 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4903 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4904 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4905 keyword.
4906
4907 Example :
4908 option splice-auto
4909
4910 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4911 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4912
4913 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4914 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4915
4916
4917option splice-request
4918no option splice-request
4919 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | yes | yes | yes
4922 Arguments : none
4923
4924 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004925 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004926 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4927 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4928 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4929 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4930
4931 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4932
4933 Example :
4934 option splice-request
4935
4936 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4937 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4938
4939 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4940 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4941
4942
4943option splice-response
4944no option splice-response
4945 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4947 yes | yes | yes | yes
4948 Arguments : none
4949
4950 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004951 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004952 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4953 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4954 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4955 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4956
4957 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4958
4959 Example :
4960 option splice-response
4961
4962 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4963 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4964
4965 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4966 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4967
4968
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004969option srvtcpka
4970no option srvtcpka
4971 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | no | yes | yes
4974 Arguments : none
4975
4976 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4977 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4978 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4979 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4980
4981 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4982 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4983 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4984 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4985
4986 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4987 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4988 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4989 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4990 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4991
4992 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4993
4994 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4995 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4996 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4997
4998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5000
5001 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5002
5003
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005004option ssl-hello-chk
5005 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 yes | no | yes | yes
5008 Arguments : none
5009
5010 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5011 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5012 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5013 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5014 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5015 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5016 hello message.
5017
5018 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5019 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5020 messages, which is appreciable.
5021
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005022 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5023 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5024 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005025
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005026 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5027
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005028
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005029option tcp-check
5030 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | no | yes | yes
5033
5034 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5035 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5036
5037 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5038 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5039 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5040
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005041 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005042 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5043 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5044 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5045 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5046 only.
5047
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005048 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005049 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5050 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5051 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5052 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005054 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005055 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5056 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005057 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005058 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5059 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5060 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5061 the respective protocols.
5062 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5063 analysed.
5064
5065 Examples :
5066 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5067 option tcp-check
5068 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5069
5070 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5071 option tcp-check
5072 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5073
5074 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5075 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005076 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005077 option tcp-check
5078 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5079 tcp-check expect +PONG
5080 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5081 tcp-check expect string role:master
5082 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5083 tcp-check expect string +OK
5084
5085 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5086 (send many headers before analyzing)
5087 option tcp-check
5088 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5089 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5090 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5091 tcp-check send \r\n
5092 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5093
5094
5095 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5096
5097
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005098option tcp-smart-accept
5099no option tcp-smart-accept
5100 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | yes | yes | no
5103 Arguments : none
5104
5105 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5106 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5107 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5108 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5109 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5110 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5111
5112 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5113 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5114 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5115 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5116
5117 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5118 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5119 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5120 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5121
5122 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5123 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5124 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5125
5126 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5127 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5128 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5129
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005130 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5131
5132
5133option tcp-smart-connect
5134no option tcp-smart-connect
5135 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5137 yes | no | yes | yes
5138 Arguments : none
5139
5140 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5141 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5142 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5143 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5144 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5145
5146 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5147 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5148 complex.
5149
5150 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5151 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5152 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5153
5154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5156
5157 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5158
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005159
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005160option tcpka
5161 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | yes | yes | yes
5164 Arguments : none
5165
5166 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5167 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5168 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5169 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5170
5171 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5172 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5173 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5174 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5175
5176 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5177 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5178 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5179 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5180 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5181
5182 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5183
5184 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5185 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5186 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5187 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5188 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5189 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5190 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5191 backends.
5192
5193 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005195
5196option tcplog
5197 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | yes | yes | yes
5200 Arguments : none
5201
5202 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5203 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5204 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5205 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5206 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5207 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5208 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5209 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5210
5211 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005213 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005214
5215
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005216option transparent
5217no option transparent
5218 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005220 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005221 Arguments : none
5222
5223 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5224 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5225 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5226 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5227 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5228 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5229 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5230 appropriate server.
5231
5232 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5233 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5234
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005235 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005236 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005238
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005239external-check command <command>
5240 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | no | yes | yes
5243
5244 Arguments :
5245 <command> is the external command to run
5246
5247 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5248 command may be set using "external-check path".
5249
5250 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5251
5252 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5253
5254 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5255 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5256 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5257 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5258 be the string "NOT_USED".
5259
5260 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5261 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5262 failed.
5263
5264 Example :
5265 external-check command /bin/true
5266
5267 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5268
5269
5270external-check path <path>
5271 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 yes | no | yes | yes
5274
5275 Arguments :
5276 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5277
5278 The default path is "".
5279
5280 Example :
5281 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5282
5283 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5284 "external-check command"
5285
5286
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005287persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005288persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005289 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5291 yes | no | yes | yes
5292 Arguments :
5293 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005294 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5295 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005296
5297 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5298 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5299 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5300 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5301 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5302 forwarded to this server.
5303
5304 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5305 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5306 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005307 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005308 a single "listen" section.
5309
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005310 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5311 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5312 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5313
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005314 Example :
5315 listen tse-farm
5316 bind :3389
5317 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5318 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5319 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5320 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5321 persist rdp-cookie
5322 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005323 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005324 balance rdp-cookie
5325 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5326 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5327
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005328 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5329 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005330
5331
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005332rate-limit sessions <rate>
5333 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | yes | yes | no
5336 Arguments :
5337 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5338 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5339
5340 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5341 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5342 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5343 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5344 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5345 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5346
5347 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5348 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5349 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5350 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5351
5352 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5353 listen smtp
5354 mode tcp
5355 bind :25
5356 rate-limit sessions 10
5357 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5358
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005359 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5360 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5361 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005362
5363 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5364
5365
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005366redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5367redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5368redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005369 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 no | yes | yes | yes
5372
5373 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005374 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005375
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005376 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005377 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005378 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5379 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5380 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005381
5382 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5383 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5384 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5385 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5386 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005387 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5388 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5389 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5390 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005391
5392 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5393 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5394 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5395 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5396 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5397 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005398 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005399 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005400 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5401 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5402 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005403
5404 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005405 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5406 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5407 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5408 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5409 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5410 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5411 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5412 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005413
5414 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5415 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5416
5417 - "drop-query"
5418 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5419 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5420 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5421 with a location-type redirect.
5422
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005423 - "append-slash"
5424 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5425 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5426 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5427 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5428
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005429 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5430 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5431 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5432 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5433 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5434 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5435 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5436
5437 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5438 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5439 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5440 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5441 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5442 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5443 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005444
5445 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5446 acl clear dst_port 80
5447 acl secure dst_port 8080
5448 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005449 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005450 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005451 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5452
5453 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005454 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5455 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5456 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005457 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005458
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005459 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5460 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5461 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5462
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005463 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005464 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005465
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005466 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5467 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5468 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005470 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005471
5472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005473redisp (deprecated)
5474redispatch (deprecated)
5475 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5477 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005478 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005479
5480 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5481 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5482 be able to access the service anymore.
5483
5484 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5485 redistribute them to a working server.
5486
5487 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5488 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5489 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005491 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5492 "option redispatch" instead.
5493
5494 See also : "option redispatch"
5495
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005496
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005497reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005498 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 no | yes | yes | yes
5501 Arguments :
5502 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5503 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005504 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005505
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005506 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5507 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5508
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005509 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5510 the last header of an HTTP request.
5511
5512 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5513 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5514 responses.
5515
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005516 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5517 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5518 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5519
5520 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5521 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005522
5523
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005524reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5525reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005526 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 no | yes | yes | yes
5529 Arguments :
5530 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5531 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5532 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5533 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5534 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5535 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5536 ignores case.
5537
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005538 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5539 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5540
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005541 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5542 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5543 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5544 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005545 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005546
5547 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5548 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5549
5550 Example :
5551 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5552 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5553 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5554
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005555 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5556 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005557
5558
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005559reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5560reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005561 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 no | yes | yes | yes
5564 Arguments :
5565 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5566 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5567 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5568 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5569 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5570 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5571
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005572 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5573 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5574
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005575 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5576 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5577 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5578 next servers.
5579
5580 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5581 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5582 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5583
5584 Example :
5585 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5586 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5587 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5588
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005589 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5590 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005591
5592
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005593reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5594reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005595 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5597 no | yes | yes | yes
5598 Arguments :
5599 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5600 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5601 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5602 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5603 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5604 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5605 case.
5606
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005607 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5608 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5609
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005610 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5611 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5612 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5613 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005614 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005615
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005616 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005617 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005618 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005619
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005620 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5621 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5622
5623 Example :
5624 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5625 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5626 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5627
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005628 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5629 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005630
5631
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005632reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5633reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005634 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5636 no | yes | yes | yes
5637 Arguments :
5638 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5639 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5640 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5641 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5642 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5643 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5644 case.
5645
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005646 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5647 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5648
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005649 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5650 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5651 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5652 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5653
5654 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5655 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5656
5657 Example :
5658 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5659 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5660 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5661 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5662
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005663 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5664 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665
5666
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005667reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5668reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 no | yes | yes | yes
5672 Arguments :
5673 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5674 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5675 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5676 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5677 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5678 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5679
5680 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5681 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5682 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5683 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005684 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005685
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005686 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5687 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5688
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5690 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5691 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5692
5693 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5694 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5695 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5696 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5697 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5698
5699 Example :
5700 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005701 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005702 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5703 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5704
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005705 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5706 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005707
5708
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005709reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5710reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005711 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5713 no | yes | yes | yes
5714 Arguments :
5715 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5716 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5717 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5718 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5719 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5720 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5721 ignores case.
5722
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005723 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5724 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5725
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005726 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5727 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005728 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5729 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5730 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005731 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5732 not set.
5733
5734 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5735 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5736 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5737 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5738 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5739
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005740 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005741 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5742 # block all others.
5743 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5744 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5745
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005746 # block bad guys
5747 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5748 reqitarpit . if badguys
5749
5750 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5751 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005752
5753
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005754retries <value>
5755 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5756 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 yes | no | yes | yes
5758 Arguments :
5759 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5760 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5761 default value is 3.
5762
5763 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5764 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5765 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5766
5767 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5768 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5769
5770 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5771 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5772
5773 See also : "option redispatch"
5774
5775
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005776rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005777 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 no | yes | yes | yes
5780 Arguments :
5781 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5782 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005783 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005784
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005785 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5786 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5787
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005788 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5789 the last header of an HTTP response.
5790
5791 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5792 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5793 responses.
5794
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005795 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5796 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005797
5798
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005799rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5800rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 no | yes | yes | yes
5804 Arguments :
5805 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5806 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5807 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5808 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5809 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5810 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5811 ignores case.
5812
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005813 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5814 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5815
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005816 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5817 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005818 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005819 client.
5820
5821 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5822 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5823 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5824
5825 Example :
5826 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005827 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005828
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005829 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5830 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005831
5832
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005833rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5834rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005835 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 no | yes | yes | yes
5838 Arguments :
5839 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5840 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5841 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5842 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5843 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5844 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5845 ignores case.
5846
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005847 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5848 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5849
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005850 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5851 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5852 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5853 case-sensitive.
5854
5855 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005856 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5857 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5858 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005859
5860 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5861 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5862
5863 Example :
5864 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5865 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5866
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005867 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5868 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005869
5870
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005871rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5872rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005873 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 no | yes | yes | yes
5876 Arguments :
5877 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5878 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5879 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5880 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5881 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5882 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5883 ignores case.
5884
5885 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5886 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5887 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5888 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005889 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005890
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005891 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5892 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5893
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005894 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5895 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5896 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5897
5898 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5899 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5900 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5901 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5902 are not case-sensitive.
5903
5904 Example :
5905 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5906 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5907
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005908 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5909 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005910
5911
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005912server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005913 Declare a server in a backend
5914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5915 no | no | yes | yes
5916 Arguments :
5917 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005918 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005919 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005920
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005921 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5922 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5923 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5924 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005925 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5926 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5927 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5928 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5929 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005930 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5931 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5932 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5933 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5934 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5935 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5936 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005937 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005938 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5939 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5940 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5941 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005943 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005944 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5945 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5946 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5947 adding this value to the client's port.
5948
5949 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5950 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005951 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005952
5953 Examples :
5954 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5955 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005956 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005957 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5958 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5959 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005960
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005961 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5962 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005963
5964
5965source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005966source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005967source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005968 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5970 yes | no | yes | yes
5971 Arguments :
5972 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5973 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005974
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005975 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005976 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5977 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5978 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5979 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5980 supported prefixes are :
5981 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5982 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5983 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005984 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005985 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5986 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5987 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5988 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005989
5990 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5991 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005992 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5993 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5994 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005995
5996 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5997 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5998 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5999 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6000 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6001 <addr>.
6002
6003 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6004 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6005 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6006 port.
6007
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006008 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6009 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6010 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6011 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006012 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006013 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6014 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6015 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6016 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6017 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6018 HTTP header.
6019
6020 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6021 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006022 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006023 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6024 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6025 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6026 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6027 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6028 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6029 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6030
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006031 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6032 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6033 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6034 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6035 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6036 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6037
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006038 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6039 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6040 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6041 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6042
6043 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6044 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6045 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6046 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6047 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6048 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6049
6050 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6051 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6052 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6053 there are two methods :
6054
6055 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6056 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6057 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6058 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6059 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6060 of the client ranges may be used.
6061
6062 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6063 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6064 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6065 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6066 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6067 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6068 same session.
6069
6070 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6071 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6072 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6073 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6074 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6075 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6076
6077 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6078 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6079 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006080 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006081
6082 Examples :
6083 backend private
6084 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6085 source 192.168.1.200
6086
6087 backend transparent_ssl1
6088 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6089 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6090
6091 backend transparent_ssl2
6092 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6093 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6094 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6095
6096 backend transparent_ssl3
6097 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6098 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6099 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6100
6101 backend transparent_smtp
6102 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6103 # with Tproxy version 4.
6104 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6105
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006106 backend transparent_http
6107 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6108 # proxy.
6109 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006111 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006112 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006114
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006115srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6116 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6118 yes | no | yes | yes
6119 Arguments :
6120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6122 as explained at the top of this document.
6123
6124 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6125 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6126 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6127 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6128 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6129 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6130 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6131
6132 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6133 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6134 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6135 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6136 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006137 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006138 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006139 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006140
6141 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6142 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6143 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6144 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6145 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6146 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6147
6148 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6149 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6150
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006151 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6152 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006153
6154
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006155stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6156 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006158 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006159
6160 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6161 matched.
6162
6163 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6164 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006166 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6167 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6168 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6169
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006170 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6171 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6172 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6173 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006174
6175 Example :
6176 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6177 backend stats_localhost
6178 stats enable
6179 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6180
6181 Example :
6182 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6183 backend stats_auth
6184 stats enable
6185 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6186 stats admin if TRUE
6187
6188 Example :
6189 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6190 userlist stats-auth
6191 group admin users admin
6192 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6193 group readonly users haproxy
6194 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6195
6196 backend stats_auth
6197 stats enable
6198 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6199 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6200 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6201 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006203 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6204 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6205 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006206
6207
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006208stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6209 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006211 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006212 Arguments :
6213 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6214
6215 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6216
6217 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6218 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6219 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6220 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6221 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6222 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6223
6224 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6225 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6226 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006227 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006228
6229 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6230 report using "stats scope".
6231
6232 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6233 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6234 unobvious parameters.
6235
6236 Example :
6237 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6238 backend public_www
6239 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6240 stats enable
6241 stats hide-version
6242 stats scope .
6243 stats uri /admin?stats
6244 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6245 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6246 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6247
6248 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6249 backend private_monitoring
6250 stats enable
6251 stats uri /admin?stats
6252 stats refresh 5s
6253
6254 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6255
6256
6257stats enable
6258 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006261 Arguments : none
6262
6263 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6264 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6265 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6266 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6267 - stats auth : no authentication
6268 - stats scope : no restriction
6269
6270 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6271 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6272 unobvious parameters.
6273
6274 Example :
6275 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6276 backend public_www
6277 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6278 stats enable
6279 stats hide-version
6280 stats scope .
6281 stats uri /admin?stats
6282 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6283 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6284 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6285
6286 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6287 backend private_monitoring
6288 stats enable
6289 stats uri /admin?stats
6290 stats refresh 5s
6291
6292 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6293
6294
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006295stats hide-version
6296 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006298 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006299 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006300
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006301 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6302 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6303 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6304 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6305 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6306 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6310 unobvious parameters.
6311
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006312 Example :
6313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6314 backend public_www
6315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006316 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006317 stats hide-version
6318 stats scope .
6319 stats uri /admin?stats
6320 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006323
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6325 backend private_monitoring
6326 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006327 stats uri /admin?stats
6328 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006329
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006331
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006332
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006333stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6335 Access control for statistics
6336
6337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6338 no | no | yes | yes
6339
6340 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6341 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6342 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6343 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6344 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6345 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6346
6347 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6348 instance.
6349
6350 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6351 about ACL usage.
6352
6353
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006354stats realm <realm>
6355 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006357 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006358 Arguments :
6359 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6360 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6361 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6362
6363 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6364 using a backslash ('\').
6365
6366 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6367 only related to authentication.
6368
6369 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6370 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6371 unobvious parameters.
6372
6373 Example :
6374 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6375 backend public_www
6376 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6377 stats enable
6378 stats hide-version
6379 stats scope .
6380 stats uri /admin?stats
6381 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6382 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6383 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6384
6385 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6386 backend private_monitoring
6387 stats enable
6388 stats uri /admin?stats
6389 stats refresh 5s
6390
6391 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6392
6393
6394stats refresh <delay>
6395 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006398 Arguments :
6399 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6400 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6401 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6402 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6403 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6404 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6405
6406 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6407 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6408 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6409 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6410
6411 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6412 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6413 unobvious parameters.
6414
6415 Example :
6416 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6417 backend public_www
6418 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6419 stats enable
6420 stats hide-version
6421 stats scope .
6422 stats uri /admin?stats
6423 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6424 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6425 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6426
6427 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6428 backend private_monitoring
6429 stats enable
6430 stats uri /admin?stats
6431 stats refresh 5s
6432
6433 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6434
6435
6436stats scope { <name> | "." }
6437 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006440 Arguments :
6441 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6442 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6443 section in which the statement appears.
6444
6445 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6446 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6447 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6448 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6449 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6450 exists.
6451
6452 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6453 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6454 unobvious parameters.
6455
6456 Example :
6457 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6458 backend public_www
6459 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6460 stats enable
6461 stats hide-version
6462 stats scope .
6463 stats uri /admin?stats
6464 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6465 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6466 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6467
6468 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6469 backend private_monitoring
6470 stats enable
6471 stats uri /admin?stats
6472 stats refresh 5s
6473
6474 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6475
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006476
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006477stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006478 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006480 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006481
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006482 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006483 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6484
6485 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6486 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6487
6488 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6489 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006490 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006491
6492 Example :
6493 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6494 backend private_monitoring
6495 stats enable
6496 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6497 stats uri /admin?stats
6498 stats refresh 5s
6499
6500 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6501 global section.
6502
6503
6504stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006505 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | yes | yes | yes
6508 Arguments : none
6509
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006510 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006511 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6512 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6513 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6514 - IP (socket, server)
6515 - cookie (backend, server)
6516
6517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006519 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006520
6521 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6522
6523
6524stats show-node [ <name> ]
6525 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006527 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006528 Arguments:
6529 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6530 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6531
6532 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6533 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006534 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006535
6536 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6537 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6538 unobvious parameters.
6539
6540 Example:
6541 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6542 backend private_monitoring
6543 stats enable
6544 stats show-node Europe-1
6545 stats uri /admin?stats
6546 stats refresh 5s
6547
6548 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6549 section.
6550
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006551
6552stats uri <prefix>
6553 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006555 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006556 Arguments :
6557 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6558 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6559 query string.
6560
6561 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6562 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6563 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6564 possible to reach it in the application.
6565
6566 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006567 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006568 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6569 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6570 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6571 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6572
6573 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6574 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6575 an address or a port to statistics only.
6576
6577 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6578 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6579 unobvious parameters.
6580
6581 Example :
6582 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6583 backend public_www
6584 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6585 stats enable
6586 stats hide-version
6587 stats scope .
6588 stats uri /admin?stats
6589 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6590 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6591 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6592
6593 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6594 backend private_monitoring
6595 stats enable
6596 stats uri /admin?stats
6597 stats refresh 5s
6598
6599 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6600
6601
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006602stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6603 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006605 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006606
6607 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006608 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006609 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6610 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6611 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6612
6613 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6614 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6615 the "stick-table" statement.
6616
6617 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6618 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6619 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6620 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6621 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6622
6623 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6624 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6625 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6626 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6627 transformation rules.
6628
6629 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6630 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6631 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6632 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6633 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6634 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6635 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6636
6637 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6638 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6639 ACL based conditions.
6640
6641 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6642 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6643 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6644 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6645
6646 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6647 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6648 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6649 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6650
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006651 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6652 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6653 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6654
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006655 Example :
6656 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6657 # last 30 minutes
6658 backend pop
6659 mode tcp
6660 balance roundrobin
6661 stick store-request src
6662 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6663 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6664 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6665
6666 backend smtp
6667 mode tcp
6668 balance roundrobin
6669 stick match src table pop
6670 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6671 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6672
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006673 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006674 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006675
6676
6677stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6678 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6680 no | no | yes | yes
6681
6682 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6683 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6684 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6685 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6686
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006687 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6688 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6689 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6690
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006691 Examples :
6692 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006693 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006694
6695 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6696 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6697 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6698
6699
6700 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6701 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6702 backend http
6703 mode http
6704 balance roundrobin
6705 stick on src table https
6706 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6707 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6708 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6709
6710 backend https
6711 mode tcp
6712 balance roundrobin
6713 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6714 stick on src
6715 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6716 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006718 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006719
6720
6721stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6722 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6724 no | no | yes | yes
6725
6726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006727 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006728 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6729 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6730 server is selected.
6731
6732 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6733 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6734 the "stick-table" statement.
6735
6736 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6737 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6738 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6739 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6740 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6741 address.
6742
6743 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6744 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6745 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6746 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6747 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6748 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6749 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6750 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6751 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6752 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6753
6754 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6755 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6756 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6757 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6758 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6759 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6760 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6761
6762 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6763 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6764 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6765 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6766
6767 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6768 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6769 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6770 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6771 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6772 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006773 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6774 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6775 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6776 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6777 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6778 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006779
6780 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6781 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6782 the request.
6783
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006784 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6785 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6786 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6787
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006788 Example :
6789 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6790 # last 30 minutes
6791 backend pop
6792 mode tcp
6793 balance roundrobin
6794 stick store-request src
6795 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6796 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6797 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6798
6799 backend smtp
6800 mode tcp
6801 balance roundrobin
6802 stick match src table pop
6803 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6804 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6805
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006806 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006807 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006808
6809
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006810stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006811 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6812 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006813 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006815 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006816
6817 Arguments :
6818 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6819 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6820 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6821 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6822
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006823 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6824 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6825 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6826 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6827
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006828 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6829 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6830 instance.
6831
6832 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6833 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6834 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6835 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6836 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6837 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006838 to 32 characters.
6839
6840 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6841 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6842 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006843 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006844 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6845 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006846
6847 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006848 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6849 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006850 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6851 increase.
6852
6853 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006854 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6855 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6856 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006857
6858 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6859 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6860 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6861 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6862 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6863 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6864 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6865 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6866 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6867 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6868 parameter (see below).
6869
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006870 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6871 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6872 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6873 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6874 soft restart.
6875
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006876 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006878 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6879 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6880 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6881 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6882 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006883 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006884 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6885 if not expiration delay is specified.
6886
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006887 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6888 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6889 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6890 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006891 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6892 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6893 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6894 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6895 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6896 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6897 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6898 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6899 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6900 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6901 types and their arguments.
6902
6903 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6904 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6905 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6906 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6907
6908 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6909 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6910 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6911 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6912
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006913 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6914 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6915 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6916 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6917 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6918 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6919
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006920 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6921 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6922 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6923 they were received.
6924
6925 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6926 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6927 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6928 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6929 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6930
6931 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6932 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6933 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6934 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6935 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6936
6937 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6938 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6939 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6940
6941 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6942 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6943 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6944 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6945 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6946
6947 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6948 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6949 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6950 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6951 the client side.
6952
6953 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6954 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6955 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6956 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6957 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6958 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6959 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6960
6961 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6962 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6963 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6964 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6965 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6966 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6967 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6968
6969 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6970 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6971 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6972 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6973 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6974 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6975
6976 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6977 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6978 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6979 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6980
6981 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6982 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6983 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6984 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6985 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6986 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6987 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6988 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6989 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6990 recommended for better fairness.
6991
6992 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6993 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6994 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6995 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6996
6997 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6998 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6999 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7000 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7001 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7002 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7003 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7004 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7005 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7006 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007007
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007008 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7009 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007010 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7011 reference it.
7012
7013 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7014 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7015 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7016 as an exclusive stickiness.
7017
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007018 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7019 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7020 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7021 something that can be ignored.
7022
7023 Example:
7024 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7025 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7026 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7027 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7028
7029 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007030 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007031
7032
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007033stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7034 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 no | no | yes | yes
7037
7038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007039 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007040 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7041 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7042 server is selected.
7043
7044 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7045 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7046 the "stick-table" statement.
7047
7048 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7049 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7050 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7051 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7052
7053 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7054 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7055 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7056 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7057 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7058 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007059 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007060 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7061 rules.
7062
7063 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7064 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7065 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7066 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7067 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7068 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7069 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7070
7071 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7072 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7073 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7074 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7075
7076 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7077 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7078 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7079 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7080 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7081 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007082 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7083 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7084 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7085 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7086 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7087 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7088 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7089 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7090 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007091
7092 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7093
7094 Example :
7095 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7096 backend https
7097 mode tcp
7098 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007099 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007100 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007101
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007102 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7103 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7104
7105 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7106 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7107 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7108
7109 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7110 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007111
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007112 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7113 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7114 # at offset 44.
7115
7116 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7117 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7118
7119 # Learn on response if server hello.
7120 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007121
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007122 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7123 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7124
7125 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7126 extraction.
7127
7128
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007129tcp-check connect [params*]
7130 Opens a new connection
7131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 no | no | yes | yes
7133
7134 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7135 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7136 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7137
7138 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7139 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7140 of the sequence.
7141
7142 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7143 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7144 do.
7145
7146 Parameters :
7147 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7148 use the TCP connection.
7149
7150 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7151 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7152 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7153
7154 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7155
7156 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7157
7158 Examples:
7159 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7160 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7161 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7162 option tcp-check
7163 tcp-check connect
7164 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7165 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7166 tcp-check send \r\n
7167 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7168 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7169 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7170 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7171 tcp-check send \r\n
7172 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7173 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7174
7175 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7176 option tcp-check
7177 tcp-check connect port 110
7178 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7179 tcp-check connect port 143
7180 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7181 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7182
7183 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7184
7185
7186tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7187 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7188 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7189 no | no | yes | yes
7190
7191 Arguments :
7192 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7193 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7194 binary.
7195 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7196 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7197 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7198
7199 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7200 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7201 with the usual backslash ('\').
7202 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7203 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7204 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7205 used upper or lower case.
7206
7207
7208 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7209
7210 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7211 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7212 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7213 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7214 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7215 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7216 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7217 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7218
7219 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7220 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7221 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7222 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7223 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7224 expression.
7225
7226 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7227 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7228 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7229 this exact hexadecimal string.
7230 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7231
7232 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7233 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7234 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7235 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7236 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7237 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7238 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7239 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7240 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7241 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7242 the null character.
7243
7244 Examples :
7245 # perform a POP check
7246 option tcp-check
7247 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7248
7249 # perform an IMAP check
7250 option tcp-check
7251 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7252
7253 # look for the redis master server
7254 option tcp-check
7255 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7256 tcp-check expect +PONG
7257 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7258 tcp-check expect string role:master
7259 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7260 tcp-check expect string +OK
7261
7262
7263 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7264 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7265
7266
7267tcp-check send <data>
7268 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7270 no | no | yes | yes
7271
7272 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7273 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7274
7275 Examples :
7276 # look for the redis master server
7277 option tcp-check
7278 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7279 tcp-check expect string role:master
7280
7281 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7282 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7283
7284
7285tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7286 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7287 tcp health check
7288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7289 no | no | yes | yes
7290
7291 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7292 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7293 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7294 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7295 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7296 hexadecimal string.
7297 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7298
7299 Examples :
7300 # redis check in binary
7301 option tcp-check
7302 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7303 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7304
7305
7306 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7307 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7308
7309
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007310tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7311 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7313 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007314 Arguments :
7315 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007316 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7317 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007319 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007320
7321 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7322 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007323 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7324 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7325 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7326 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7327 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7328 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007330 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7331 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7332 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7333 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007334
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007335 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007336 - accept :
7337 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7338 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7339 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007341 - reject :
7342 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7343 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7344 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7345 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7346 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7347 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7348 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7349 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7350 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7351 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7352 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7353 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007354
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007355 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7356 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7357 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7358 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7359 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7360 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7361 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7362 hosts.
7363
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007364 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7365 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7366 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7367 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7368 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7369 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7370 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7371 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7372 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7373 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7374 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7375
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007376 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007377 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7378 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7379 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007380 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7381 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007382 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007383 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7384 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7385 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7386 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7387 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007389 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007390 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007391 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007392 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7393 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7394 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7395 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007397 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7398 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7399 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7400 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007401
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007402 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7403 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7404 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7405 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7406 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007407 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7408 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7409 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7410 layer7 information is extracted.
7411
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007412 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7413 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7414 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7415 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7416 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7419 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7420 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007421
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007422 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7423 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7424 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007427 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007428 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007429
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7431 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7432 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007434 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007435 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7436 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007437
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007438 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7439
7440 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7441
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007442 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7443
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007444 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007445
7446
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007447tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7448 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007450 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007451 Arguments :
7452 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007453 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007454 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7455 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007457 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7460 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7461 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7462 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7463 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007464
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007465 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7466 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7467 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7468 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007469 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7470 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7471 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7472 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7473 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7474 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007475 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007476 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007478 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7479 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7480 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7481 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007482
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007483 Four types of actions are supported :
7484 - accept : the request is accepted
7485 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7486 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007487 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007489 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7490 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007491
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007492 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7493 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7494 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7495 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7496 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7497 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007499 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007500 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7501 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007503 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007504 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7505 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7506 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7507 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007508 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7509 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7510 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007511
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007512 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7513 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7514 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7515 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7516
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007517 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7519 # and reject everything else.
7520 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7521 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007522 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 tcp-request content reject
7524
7525 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007526 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7527 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7528 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007529 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007530
7531 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7532 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7533 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007534 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007535 tcp-request content reject
7536
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007537 Example:
7538 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7539 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007540 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007541
7542 Example:
7543 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7544 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007545 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007546
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7548 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7549
7550 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007551 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007552 # protecting all our sites
7553 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007554 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7555 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007556 ...
7557 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7558
7559 backend http_dynamic
7560 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007561 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007562 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007563 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7564 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7565 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007566 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007568 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007569
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007570 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007571
7572
7573tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7574 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007576 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007577 Arguments :
7578 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7579 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7580 as explained at the top of this document.
7581
7582 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7583 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7584 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7585 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7586 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7587
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007588 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7589 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7590 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7591 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7592
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007593 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7594 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007595 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007596 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007597 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7598 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7599 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7600 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601
7602 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7603 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7604 it pass through unaffected.
7605
7606 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7607 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7608 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007609 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007610 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7611 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007612 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7613 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7614 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007615
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007616 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007617 "timeout client".
7618
7619
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007620tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7621 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7623 no | no | yes | yes
7624 Arguments :
7625 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007626 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007627
7628 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7629
7630 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7631 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7632 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007633 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7634 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007635
7636 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7637
7638 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7639 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7640 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7641 inserted.
7642
7643 Two types of actions are supported :
7644 - accept :
7645 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7646 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7647 the rules evaluation.
7648
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007649 - close :
7650 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7651 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7652 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7653 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7654 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7655 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007656 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007657 protocols.
7658
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007659 - reject :
7660 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7661 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007662 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007663
7664 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7665 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7666 for changing the default action to a reject.
7667
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007668 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7669 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7670 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7671 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007672 period.
7673
7674 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7675
7676 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7677
7678
7679tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7680 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7682 no | no | yes | yes
7683 Arguments :
7684 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7685 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7686 as explained at the top of this document.
7687
7688 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7689
7690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007691timeout check <timeout>
7692 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7693 established.
7694
7695 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7696 yes | no | yes | yes
7697 Arguments:
7698 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7699 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7700 as explained at the top of this document.
7701
7702 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7703 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7704 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7705 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007706 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7707 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7708 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007709
7710 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7711 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7712
7713 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7714 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007715 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007716
7717 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7718 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7719 forget about it.
7720
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007721 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7722 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007723
7724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007725timeout client <timeout>
7726timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7727 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7729 yes | yes | yes | no
7730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7733 as explained at the top of this document.
7734
7735 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7736 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7737 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7738 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7739 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7740 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7741 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7742 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007743 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007744 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007745 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7746 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007747 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7748 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007749
7750 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7751 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7752 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7753 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7754 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7755 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7756
7757 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7758 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7759 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7760
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007761 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007762
7763
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007764timeout client-fin <timeout>
7765 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7767 yes | yes | yes | no
7768 Arguments :
7769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7771 as explained at the top of this document.
7772
7773 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7774 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7775 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7776 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7777 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7778 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7779 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7780 down in one direction.
7781
7782 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7783 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7784 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7785
7786 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7787
7788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007789timeout connect <timeout>
7790timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7791 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 yes | no | yes | yes
7794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7797 as explained at the top of this document.
7798
7799 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007800 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007801 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007802 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007803 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7804 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007805
7806 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7807 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7808 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7809 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7810 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7811 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7812
7813 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7814 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7815 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7816
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007817 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7818 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007819
7820
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007821timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7822 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7824 yes | yes | yes | yes
7825 Arguments :
7826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7828 as explained at the top of this document.
7829
7830 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7831 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7832 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7833 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7834 once the request has started to present itself.
7835
7836 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7837 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7838 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7839 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7840 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7841
7842 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7843 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7844 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7845 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7846
7847 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7848 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7849 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7850 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7851 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007852 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007853
7854 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7855 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7856 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7857 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7858
7859 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7860
7861
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007862timeout http-request <timeout>
7863 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7869 as explained at the top of this document.
7870
7871 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7872 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7873 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7874 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7875 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7876 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7877 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007878 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7879 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7880 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7881 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7882 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7883 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7884 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007885
7886 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7887 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007888 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7889 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007890
7891 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7892 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7893 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7894 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7895 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7896
7897 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007898 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7899 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7900 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007901
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007902 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007903
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007904
7905timeout queue <timeout>
7906 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7908 yes | no | yes | yes
7909 Arguments :
7910 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7912 as explained at the top of this document.
7913
7914 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7915 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7916 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7917 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7918 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7919
7920 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7921 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7922 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7923 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7924
7925 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7926
7927
7928timeout server <timeout>
7929timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7930 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 yes | no | yes | yes
7933 Arguments :
7934 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7936 as explained at the top of this document.
7937
7938 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7939 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7940 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7941 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7942 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7943 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7944 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7945
7946 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7947 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7948 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7949 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7950 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007951 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007952 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007953 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7954 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7955 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7956 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007957
7958 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7959 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7960 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7961 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7962 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7963 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7964
7965 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7966 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7967 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7968
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007969 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007970
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007971
7972timeout server-fin <timeout>
7973 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7975 yes | no | yes | yes
7976 Arguments :
7977 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7978 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7979 as explained at the top of this document.
7980
7981 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7982 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7983 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7984 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7985 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7986 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7987 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7988 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7989 situations, it should not be needed.
7990
7991 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7992 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7993 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7994
7995 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7996
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007997
7998timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007999 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments :
8003 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8004 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8005 as explained at the top of this document.
8006
8007 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8008 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8009 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8010
8011 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8012 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8013 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8014 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008015 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008016
8017 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8018
8019
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008020timeout tunnel <timeout>
8021 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8023 yes | no | yes | yes
8024 Arguments :
8025 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8026 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8027 as explained at the top of this document.
8028
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008029 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008030 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8031 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8032 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8033 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8034 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8035 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8036 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8037 specified.
8038
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008039 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8040 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8041 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8042 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8043 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8044 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8045 state.
8046
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008047 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8048 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8049 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8050 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8051 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8052
8053 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8054 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8055 forget about it.
8056
8057 Example :
8058 defaults http
8059 option http-server-close
8060 timeout connect 5s
8061 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008062 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008063 timeout server 30s
8064 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8065
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008066 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008067
8068
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008069transparent (deprecated)
8070 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008072 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008073 Arguments : none
8074
8075 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8076 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8077 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8078 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8079 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8080 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8081 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8082 appropriate server.
8083
8084 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8085
8086 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8087 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8088
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008089 See also: "option transparent"
8090
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008091unique-id-format <string>
8092 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 yes | yes | yes | no
8095 Arguments :
8096 <string> is a log-format string.
8097
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008098 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8099 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8100 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8101 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008102
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008103 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8104 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8105 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8106 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8107 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8108 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8109 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8110 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008111
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008112 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8113 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008114
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008115 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008116
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008117 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008118
8119 will generate:
8120
8121 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8122
8123 See also: "unique-id-header"
8124
8125unique-id-header <name>
8126 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8128 yes | yes | yes | no
8129 Arguments :
8130 <name> is the name of the header.
8131
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008132 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8133 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008134
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008135 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008136
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008137 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008138 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8139
8140 will generate:
8141
8142 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8143
8144 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008145
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008146use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008147 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 no | yes | yes | no
8150 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008151 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8152 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008153
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008154 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8155 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008156
8157 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8158 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8159 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008160 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8161 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8162 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8163 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008164
8165 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8166 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8167 assign the backend.
8168
8169 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8170 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8171 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8172 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8173 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8174 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8175
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008176 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008177 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008178 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8179 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8180 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8181
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008182 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8183 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8184 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8185 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8186 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8187 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8188 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8189 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8190 cannot be forced from the request.
8191
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008192 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008193 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8194 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8195
8196 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8197 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008198
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008199
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008200use-server <server> if <condition>
8201use-server <server> unless <condition>
8202 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 no | no | yes | yes
8205 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008206 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008207
8208 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8209
8210 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8211 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8212 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8213
8214 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8215 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8216 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8217 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8218 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8219 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8220 matches will assign the server.
8221
8222 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8223 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8224 with the next rules until one matches.
8225
8226 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8227 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8228 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8229 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8230
8231 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8232 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8233 stripped.
8234
8235 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8236 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8237 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8238 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8239
8240 Example :
8241 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8242 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8243 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8244 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8245 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8246 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8247 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8248 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8249 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8250
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008251 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008252
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008253
82545. Bind and Server options
8255--------------------------
8256
8257The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8258depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8259settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8260written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8261described in this section.
8262
8263
82645.1. Bind options
8265-----------------
8266
8267The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8268as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8269no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8270parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8271while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8272provided immediately after the setting name.
8273
8274The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8275
8276accept-proxy
8277 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008278 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8279 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008280 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8281 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8282 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8283 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8284 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8285 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8286 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008287 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8288 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008289
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008290alpn <protocols>
8291 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8292 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8293 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8294 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8295 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8296 initial NPN extension.
8297
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008298backlog <backlog>
8299 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8300 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8301
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008302ecdhe <named curve>
8303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008304 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8305 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008306
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008307ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8309 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8310 client's certificate.
8311
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008312ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8314 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8315 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8316 error is ignored.
8317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008318ciphers <ciphers>
8319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8320 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008321 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008322 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8323 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8324
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008325crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8327 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8328 to verify client's certificate.
8329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008330crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8332 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8333 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8334 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8335 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8336 file.
8337
8338 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8339 are loaded.
8340
8341 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008342 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8343 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008344 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8345 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8346 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8347 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8348 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8349 www.sub.example.org).
8350
8351 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8352 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8353 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8354 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8355 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8356
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008357 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008358
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008359 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8360 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008361 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008362 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8363 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8364 clients).
8365
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008366 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8367 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8368 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8369 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8370 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8371 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8372 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8373 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8374 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8375 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8376 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8377 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8378 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8379
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008380crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8382 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008383 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008384 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008385
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008386crt-list <file>
8387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008388 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8389 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008390
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008391 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008392
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008393 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8394 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8395 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8396 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8397 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8398 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8399 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8400 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008401
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008402defer-accept
8403 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8404 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8405 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8406 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8407 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8408 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8409 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8410 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8411 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8412 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8413 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8414
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008415force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008416 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008417 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8418 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8419
8420force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008422 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8423
8424force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008425 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008426 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8427
8428force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008429 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008430 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008432gid <gid>
8433 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8434 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8435 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8436 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8437 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8438
8439group <group>
8440 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8441 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8442 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8443 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8444 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8445
8446id <id>
8447 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8448 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8449 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8450 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8451
8452interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008453 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8454 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8455 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8456 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8457 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8458 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8459 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008460
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008461level <level>
8462 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8463 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8464 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8465 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8466 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8467 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8468 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8469 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8470 counters).
8471 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8472 all counters).
8473
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008474maxconn <maxconn>
8475 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8476 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8477 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8478 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8479 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8480 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8481 eat all memory.
8482
8483mode <mode>
8484 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8485 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8486 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8487 UNIX sockets.
8488
8489mss <maxseg>
8490 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8491 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8492 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8493 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8494 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8495 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8496 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8497 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8498 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8499 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8500 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8501
8502name <name>
8503 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8504 page.
8505
8506nice <nice>
8507 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8508 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8509 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8510 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8511 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8512 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8513 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8514 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8515 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8516 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8517 one for an RDP socket.
8518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008519no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008521 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008522 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008523 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8524 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008525
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008526no-tls-tickets
8527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8528 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8529 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8530 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8531
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008532no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008534 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008535 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8536 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8537 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008538
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008539no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008541 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008542 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8543 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8544 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008545
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008546no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008548 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008549 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8550 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8551 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008552
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008553npn <protocols>
8554 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8555 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8556 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8557 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008558 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8559 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008560
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008561process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8562 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8563 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8564 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8565 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8566 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8567 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8568 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008569 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8570 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8571 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8572 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8573 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8574 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8575 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008576
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008577ssl
8578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008579 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008580 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8581 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8582 to deciphered contents.
8583
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008584strict-sni
8585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8586 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8587 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8588 See the "crt" option for more information.
8589
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008590tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008591 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008592 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8593 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8594 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8595 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8596 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8597 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8598 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008599 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8600 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8601 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008602
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008603transparent
8604 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8605 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8606 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8607 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8608 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8609 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8610 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8611 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8612 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8613 so check for support with your vendor.
8614
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008615v4v6
8616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8617 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8618 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8619 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008620 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008621
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008622v6only
8623 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8624 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8625 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008626 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8627 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008629uid <uid>
8630 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8631 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8632 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8633 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8634 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8635
8636user <user>
8637 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8638 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8639 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8640 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8641 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8642
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008643verify [none|optional|required]
8644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8645 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8646 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8647 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8648 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008649 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8650 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8651 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8652 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086545.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008655------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008657The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8658which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8659arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8660settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8661after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8662Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8663address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008665 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008666 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008668The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008669
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008670addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008671 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8672 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8673 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8674 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8675 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008677 Supported in default-server: No
8678
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008679agent-check
8680 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008681 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8682 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8683 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8684 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008685
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008686 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008687 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8688 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8689
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008690 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8691 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008692
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008693 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8694 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8695 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008696
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008697 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8698 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8699 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008701 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8702 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8703 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8704 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8705 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8706 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8707 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008708
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008709 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8710 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008711
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008712 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8713 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8714 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8715 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8716 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8717 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8718 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8719 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8720 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008721
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008722 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8723 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008724 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8725 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8726 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8727 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008729 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8730 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008731
8732 Supported in default-server: No
8733
8734agent-inter <delay>
8735 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8736 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8737
8738 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8739 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8740 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8741 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8742 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8743 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8744 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8745 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8746 of backends use the same servers.
8747
8748 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8749
8750 Supported in default-server: Yes
8751
8752agent-port <port>
8753 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8754
8755 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8756
8757 Supported in default-server: Yes
8758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008759backup
8760 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8761 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8762 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8763 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8764 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8765 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008767 Supported in default-server: No
8768
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008769ca-file <cafile>
8770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8771 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8772 server's certificate.
8773
8774 Supported in default-server: No
8775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008776check
8777 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008778 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8779 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8780 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8781 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8782 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8783 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8784 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008785 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8786 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8787 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008789 Supported in default-server: No
8790
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008791check-send-proxy
8792 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8793 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8794 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8795 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8796 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8797 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8798 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8799
8800 Supported in default-server: No
8801
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008802check-ssl
8803 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8804 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8805 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8806 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008807 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008808 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8809 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8810 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8811 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8812
8813 Supported in default-server: No
8814
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008815ciphers <ciphers>
8816 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008817 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008818 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8819 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8820 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8821 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8822 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8823 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8824
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008825 Supported in default-server: No
8826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008827cookie <value>
8828 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8829 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8830 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8831 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8832 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8833 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8834 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008836 Supported in default-server: No
8837
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008838crl-file <crlfile>
8839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8840 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8841 to verify server's certificate.
8842
8843 Supported in default-server: No
8844
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008845crt <cert>
8846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8847 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8848 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8849 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8850 certificate request.
8851
8852 Supported in default-server: No
8853
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008854disabled
8855 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8856 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8857 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8858 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8859 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8860
8861 Supported in default-server: No
8862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008863error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008864 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8865 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8866 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008868 Supported in default-server: Yes
8869
8870 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008873 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8874 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8875 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008877 Supported in default-server: Yes
8878
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008879force-sslv3
8880 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8881 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8882 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8883
8884 Supported in default-server: No
8885
8886force-tlsv10
8887 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8888 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8889
8890 Supported in default-server: No
8891
8892force-tlsv11
8893 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8894 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8895
8896 Supported in default-server: No
8897
8898force-tlsv12
8899 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8900 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8901
8902 Supported in default-server: No
8903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008904id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008905 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8906 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8907 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008908
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008909 Supported in default-server: No
8910
8911inter <delay>
8912fastinter <delay>
8913downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008914 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8915 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8916 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8917 between checks depending on the server state :
8918
8919 Server state | Interval used
8920 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8921 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8922 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8923 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8924 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8925 or yet unchecked. |
8926 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8927 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8928 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008930 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8931 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8932 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8933 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008934 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8935 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8936 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8937 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8938 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008939
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008940 Supported in default-server: Yes
8941
8942maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008943 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8944 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8945 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8946 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8947 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8948 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8949 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8950 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008952 Supported in default-server: Yes
8953
8954maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008955 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8956 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8957 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8958 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8959 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8960 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8961 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008963 Supported in default-server: Yes
8964
8965minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008966 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8967 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8968 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8969 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8970 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8971 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008972 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008975 Supported in default-server: Yes
8976
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008977no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008978 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8979 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008980 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008981
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008982 Supported in default-server: No
8983
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008984no-tls-tickets
8985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8986 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8987 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8988 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8989
8990 Supported in default-server: No
8991
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008992no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008993 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008994 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8995 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008996 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8997 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008998
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008999 Supported in default-server: No
9000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009001no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009002 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9004 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009005 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9006 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009007
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009008 Supported in default-server: No
9009
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009010no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009011 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009012 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9013 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009014 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9015 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009016
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009017 Supported in default-server: No
9018
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009019non-stick
9020 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9021 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9022 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9023
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009024 Supported in default-server: No
9025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009026observe <mode>
9027 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9028 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9029 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9030 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9031 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9032 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009033 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009035 Supported in default-server: No
9036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009037 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009039on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009040 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9041 Currently, four modes are available:
9042 - fastinter: force fastinter
9043 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9044 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9045 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9046 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009048 Supported in default-server: Yes
9049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009050 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9051
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009052on-marked-down <action>
9053 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9054 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009055 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9056 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9057 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9058 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9059 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9060 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9061 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9062 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009063
9064 Actions are disabled by default
9065
9066 Supported in default-server: Yes
9067
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009068on-marked-up <action>
9069 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9070 Currently one action is available:
9071 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9072 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9073 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9074 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9075 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9076 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9077 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9078 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9079
9080 Actions are disabled by default
9081
9082 Supported in default-server: Yes
9083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009084port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009085 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9086 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9087 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9088 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9089 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9090 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009092 Supported in default-server: Yes
9093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009094redir <prefix>
9095 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9096 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9097 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9098 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9099 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9100 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9101 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9102 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009103 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009104 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9105 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9106 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9107 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9108 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9109
9110 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009112 Supported in default-server: No
9113
9114rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009115 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9116 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9117 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009119 Supported in default-server: Yes
9120
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009121send-proxy
9122 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9123 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9124 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9125 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9126 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9127 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9128 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9129 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9130 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009131 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9132 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9133 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9134 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9135 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009136
9137 Supported in default-server: No
9138
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009139send-proxy-v2
9140 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9141 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9142 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9143 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9144 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9145 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9146 option of the "bind" keyword.
9147
9148 Supported in default-server: No
9149
9150send-proxy-v2-ssl
9151 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9152 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9153 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9154 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9155 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9156 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9157 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9158 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9159
9160 Supported in default-server: No
9161
9162send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9163 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9164 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9165 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9166 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9167 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9168 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9169 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9170 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9171 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9172
9173 Supported in default-server: No
9174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009175slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009176 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9177 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9178 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9179 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9180 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9181 parameters :
9182
9183 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9184 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9185
9186 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9187 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9188 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9189 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9190
9191 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9192 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9193 seen as failed.
9194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009195 Supported in default-server: Yes
9196
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009197source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009198source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009199source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009200 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9201 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9202 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9203 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9204
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009205 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9206 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9207 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9208 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9209 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9210 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9211 server.
9212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009213 Supported in default-server: No
9214
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009215ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009216 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9217 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9218 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9219 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9220 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9221 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009222 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009223
9224 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009226track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009227 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9228 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9229 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9230 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009231 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009233 Supported in default-server: No
9234
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009235verify [none|required]
9236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009237 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9238 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9239 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9240 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009241 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9242 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9243 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009244
9245 Supported in default-server: No
9246
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009247verifyhost <hostname>
9248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9249 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9250 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9251 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9252 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9253 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9254
9255 Supported in default-server: No
9256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009257weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009258 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9259 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9260 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009261 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9262 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9263 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9264 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9265 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9266 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009268 Supported in default-server: Yes
9269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009270
92716. HTTP header manipulation
9272---------------------------
9273
9274In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9275response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9276request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9277which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009278against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009279
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009280If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9281to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9282but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9283HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9284stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9285because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9286a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9287still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009289This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9290in section 4.2 :
9291
9292 - reqadd <string>
9293 - reqallow <search>
9294 - reqiallow <search>
9295 - reqdel <search>
9296 - reqidel <search>
9297 - reqdeny <search>
9298 - reqideny <search>
9299 - reqpass <search>
9300 - reqipass <search>
9301 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9302 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9303 - reqtarpit <search>
9304 - reqitarpit <search>
9305 - rspadd <string>
9306 - rspdel <search>
9307 - rspidel <search>
9308 - rspdeny <search>
9309 - rspideny <search>
9310 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9311 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9312
9313With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9314is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9315parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9316prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9317Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9318
9319 \t for a tab
9320 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9321 \n for a new line (LF)
9322 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9323 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9324 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9325 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9326 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9327
9328The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9329portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9330above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9331regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9333is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9334
9335The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9336after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9337
9338Notes related to these keywords :
9339---------------------------------
9340 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9341 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9342 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9343
9344 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9345 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9346 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9347
9348 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9349 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9350 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9351 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9352 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9353
9354 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9355 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9356 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9357 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9358 useless headers before adding new ones.
9359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009360 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009361 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9362
9363 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9364 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9365 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9366
9367 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9368 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009369 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009370
9371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9373----------------------------------
9374
9375Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9376client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9377The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9378these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9379but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9380data called patterns.
9381
9382
93837.1. ACL basics
9384---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009385
9386The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9387content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9388from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9389simple :
9390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009391 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009392 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009393 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9394 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009396The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9397adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009398
9399In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009401 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009402
9403This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9404Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9405and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009406an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9407conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9408as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9409are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410
9411ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9412'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9413which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9414
9415There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9416performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9419specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9420this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009421methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9422ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423
9424Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9425 - boolean
9426 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9427 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9428 - string
9429 - data block
9430
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009431Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9432converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9433would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9434The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9435which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9436
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009437Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9438keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9439fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9440which are summarized in the table below :
9441
9442 +---------------------+-----------------+
9443 | Sample or converter | Default |
9444 | output type | matching method |
9445 +---------------------+-----------------+
9446 | boolean | bool |
9447 +---------------------+-----------------+
9448 | integer | int |
9449 +---------------------+-----------------+
9450 | ip | ip |
9451 +---------------------+-----------------+
9452 | string | str |
9453 +---------------------+-----------------+
9454 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9455 +---------------------+-----------------+
9456
9457Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9458matching method, see below.
9459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009460The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9461 - boolean
9462 - integer or integer range
9463 - IP address / network
9464 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9465 - regular expression
9466 - hex block
9467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009468The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9469
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009470 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9471 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009472 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009473 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009474 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009475 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009476 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009478The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9479read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9480if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9481lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9482will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9483beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9484a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9485lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9486exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9487
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009488The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9489parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9490ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9491a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9492check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9493
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009494The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9495socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9496file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009498Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9499loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9500
9501 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9502
9503In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9504the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9505case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9506as well.
9507
9508The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9509sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9510do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9511methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9512is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9513obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9514followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9515default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9516that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9517string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9518
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009519The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9520By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9521string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9522resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9523server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9524waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9525flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9526function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9529sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9530be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009531
9532 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9533 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9535 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9536 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9537 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009538
9539 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9540 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009541 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009542
9543 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009544 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009545
9546 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009547 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009548
9549 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9550 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9551
9552 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9553 binary or string samples.
9554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9556 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9559 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9560 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009562 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9563 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009565 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9566 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9569 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9572 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009573 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009575 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9576 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9577 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009578
9579For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9580request, it is possible to do :
9581
9582 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9583
9584In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9585buffer, one would use the following acl :
9586
9587 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9588
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009589On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9590possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9591
9592 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9595criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9596method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9597to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9598criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9599the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009602the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9603For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9606 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9607 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9608 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009609
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009610
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009611The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9612types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9613combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9614brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9615default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009617 +-------------------------------------------------+
9618 | Input sample type |
9619 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009620 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009621 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9622 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9623 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009624 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009626 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009628 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009630 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009632 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009634 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009636 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009638 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009640 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009642 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009644 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9646 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009648
9649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096507.1.1. Matching booleans
9651------------------------
9652
9653In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9654Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9655When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9656that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9657
9658Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9659return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9660"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096637.1.2. Matching integers
9664------------------------
9665
9666Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9667enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9668to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9669
9670Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9671matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9672lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009673
9674For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9675unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9676representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9677
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009678As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9679two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9680instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9681ranges and operators.
9682
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009683For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009684operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9685Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9686of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009688Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009689
9690 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9691 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9692 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9693 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9694 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009696For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009697
9698 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9699
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009700This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9701
9702 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097057.1.3. Matching strings
9706-----------------------
9707
9708String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9709different forms :
9710
9711 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9712 patterns ;
9713
9714 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9715 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9716
9717 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9718 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9719
9720 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9721 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9722
9723 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9724 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9725 matches.
9726
9727 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9728 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9729 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009730
9731String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9732exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9733characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9734string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9735to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009736before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009737
9738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097397.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9740---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009741
9742Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9743they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9744possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9745passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9746the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009747the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9748match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009749
9750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097517.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9752-------------------------------------
9753
9754It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9755not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9756a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9757to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9758digits may be used upper or lower case.
9759
9760Example :
9761 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9762 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9763
9764
97657.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9766---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009767
9768IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9769netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9770within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009771host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009772difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9773at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9774does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9775parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009776
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009777IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9778Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9779trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9780IPv6 patterns.
9781
9782HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9783following situations :
9784 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9785 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9786 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9787 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9788 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9789 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9790 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9791 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9792 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9793 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795
97967.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9797----------------------------------
9798
9799Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9800combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9801
9802 - AND (implicit)
9803 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9804 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009806A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009810Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9811indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009813For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9814"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9815requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9816is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9817
9818 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9819 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9820 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9821 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9822
9823To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9824and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9825
9826 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9827 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9828 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9829 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9830
9831 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9832 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9833 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9834 use_backend www if host_www
9835
9836It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9837expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9838be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9839the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9840
9841 The following rule :
9842
9843 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9844 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9845
9846 Can also be written that way :
9847
9848 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9849
9850It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9851to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9852simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9853sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9854good use is the following :
9855
9856 With named ACLs :
9857
9858 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9859 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9860 monitor fail if site_dead
9861
9862 With anonymous ACLs :
9863
9864 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9865
9866See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9867
9868
98697.3. Fetching samples
9870---------------------
9871
9872Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9873against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9874sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9875ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9876of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9877available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9878
9879This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9880Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9881compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9882deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9883
9884The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9885matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9886method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9887indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9888
9889As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9890when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9891mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9892the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9893ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9894
9895Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9896multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9897when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9898incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9899are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9900is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9901all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9902
9903Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9904 - name
9905 - name(arg1)
9906 - name(arg1,arg2)
9907
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009908
99097.3.1. Converters
9910-----------------
9911
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009912Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9913of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9914is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9915was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9916has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9917unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9918
9919These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9920sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9921the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9922support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009924The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009925
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009926base64
9927 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9928 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9929 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9930
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009931lower
9932 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9933 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9934 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009936upper
9937 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9938 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9939 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009941hex
9942 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9943 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9944 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9945 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009946
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009947ipmask(<mask>)
9948 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9949 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9950 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9951 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009953http_date([<offset>])
9954 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9955 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9956 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9957 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9958 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9959 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009960
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009961language(<value>[,<default>])
9962 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9963 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9964 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9965 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9966 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9967 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9968 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9969 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9970 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9971 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9972 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9973 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009974
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009975 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009977 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9978 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009979
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009980 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9981 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9982 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9983 use_backend spanish if es
9984 use_backend french if fr
9985 use_backend english if en
9986 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009987
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009988map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9989map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9990map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9991 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9992 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9993 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9994 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9995 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9996 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9997 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9998 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009999
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010000 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10001 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10002 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010004 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10005 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010007 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10008 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10009 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10010 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010011 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10012 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010013 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10014 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10015 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10016 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10017 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10018 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10019 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10020 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10021 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10022 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10023 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10024 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10025 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10026 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010028 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10029 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10030 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10031 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10032 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010033
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010034 Example :
10035
10036 # this is a comment and is ignored
10037 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10038 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10039 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10040 | | | `---------- value
10041 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10042 | `---------------------------- key
10043 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10044
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100467.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010047--------------------------------------------
10048
10049A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10050not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10051"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10052The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10053
10054always_false : boolean
10055 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10056 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10057
10058always_true : boolean
10059 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10060 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10061
10062avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010063 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010064 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10065 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10066 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10067 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10068 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10069 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10070 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10071 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10072 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10073 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10074 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10075 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10076 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010078be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010079 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10080 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10081 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10082 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10083 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010085be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10087 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10088 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10089 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10090 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10091 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010092
10093 Example :
10094 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10095 backend dynamic
10096 mode http
10097 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10098 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010100connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10101 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010102 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010103 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10104 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010105
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010106 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010107 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010108 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10109
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010110 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10111 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010112
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010113 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010114 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010116 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10117 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010118 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010119 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010120
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010121 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10122 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010124 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010125
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010126date([<offset>]) : integer
10127 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10128 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10129 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10130 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010131 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10132
10133 Example :
10134
10135 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10136 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010137
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010138env(<name>) : string
10139 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10140 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10141 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10142 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10143 certain way.
10144
10145 Examples :
10146 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10147 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10148
10149 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10150 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010152fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10153 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010154 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10155 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010156 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10157 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10158 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10159 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10160 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010162fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10163 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10164 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10165 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10166 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10167 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10168 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10169 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10170 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010171
10172 Example :
10173 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10174 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10175 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10176 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10177 frontend mail
10178 bind :25
10179 mode tcp
10180 maxconn 100
10181 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10182 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10183 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10184 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10188 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10189 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010190 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10191 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10192 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010194queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010195 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10196 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10197 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010198 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10199 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10200 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10201 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10202 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10203
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010204rand([<range>]) : integer
10205 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10206 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10207 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10208 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10209 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10213 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10214 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10215 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10216 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10217 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10218 methods.
10219
10220srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10221 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10222 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10223 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10224 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10225 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10226 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10227 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10228
10229srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10230 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10231 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010232 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010233 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10234 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10235 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10236 overloading servers).
10237
10238 Example :
10239 # Redirect to a separate back
10240 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10241 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10242 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10243
10244table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10245 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10246 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10247
10248table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10249 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10250 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10251 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10252
10253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102547.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010255----------------------------------
10256
10257The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10258closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10259methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10260sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10261TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010262the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10263counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10264"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010265argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10266the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10267this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010268
10269be_id : integer
10270 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10271 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10272
10273dst : ip
10274 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10275 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10276 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10277 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10278 RFC 4291.
10279
10280dst_conn : integer
10281 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10282 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10283 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10284 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10285 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10286 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10287 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10288 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290dst_port : integer
10291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10292 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10293 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10294 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10295 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10296 an HTTP header.
10297
10298fe_id : integer
10299 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10300 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10301 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010303sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010304sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10305sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10306sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010307 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10308 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10309 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010311sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010312sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10313sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10314sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010315 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10316 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10317 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010319sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010320sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10321sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10322sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010323 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10324 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010325 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10326 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10327 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010328
10329 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10330 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010331 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10332 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10333 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010334 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10335 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10336
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010337sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010338sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10339sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10340sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010341 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10342 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010344sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010345sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10346sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10347sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010348 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10349 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10350 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010352sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010353sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10354sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10355sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010356 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10357 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10358 See also src_conn_rate.
10359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010360sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010361sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10362sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10363sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010364 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010365 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010366
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010367sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010368sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10369sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10370sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010371 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10372 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10373 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010374 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10375 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10376 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010378sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010379sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10380sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10381sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010382 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10383 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10384 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010386sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010387sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10388sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10389sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010390 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10391 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10392 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10393 src_http_err_rate.
10394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010395sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010396sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10397sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10398sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010399 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10400 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10401 src_http_req_cnt.
10402
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010403sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010404sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10405sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10406sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10408 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10409 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10410 src_http_req_rate.
10411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010412sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010413sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10414sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10415sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010416 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010417 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10418 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10419 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10420 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010421
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010422 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10423 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010424 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010426sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010427sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10428sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10429sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10431 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10432 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10433 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010435sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010436sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10437sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10438sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010439 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10440 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10441 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10442 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010444sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010445sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10446sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10447sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010448 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10449 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10450 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10451 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010452 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010453 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10454
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010455sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010456sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10457sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10458sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010459 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10460 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10461 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10462 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10463 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010464 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010466sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010467sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10468sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10469sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010470 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10471 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10472 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010474sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010475sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10476sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10477sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010478 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10479 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010480 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010481 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10482 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10484 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10485 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487so_id : integer
10488 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10489 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10490 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492src : ip
10493 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10494 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10495 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10496 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10497 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10498 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10499 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010500
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010501 Example:
10502 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10503 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010505src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10506 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10507 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10508 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010509 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010511src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10512 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10513 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010514 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010515 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10518 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10519 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10520 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10521 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10522 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10523 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010524
10525 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10526 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10527 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10528 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010529 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010530 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10531 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010533src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010534 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010536 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010537 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010539src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010540 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10542 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010543 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010545src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10546 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10547 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10548 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010549 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010552 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010553 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010554 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010555 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010557src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010558 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010560 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10561 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010562 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10563 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10564 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10567 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10568 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010569 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010570 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10574 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10575 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10576 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10577 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010578 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10581 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10582 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10583 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010584 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010586src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10587 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10588 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10589 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010590 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010591 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010593src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10594 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10595 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10596 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010597 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10599 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010600
10601 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010602 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010603 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10606 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10607 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10608 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10609 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010610 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10611 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10614 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10615 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010616 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10617 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010618 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620src_port : integer
10621 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10622 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10623 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10624 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10627 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010628 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10629 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10630 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010631 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10634 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10635 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10636 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10637 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010638 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10641 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10642 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10643 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10644 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10645 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10646 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10647 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10648 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010649
10650 Example :
10651 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10652 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10653 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10654 listen ssh
10655 bind :22
10656 mode tcp
10657 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010658 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010660 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010662srv_id : integer
10663 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10664 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10665 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010666
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010667
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106687.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010671The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10672closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10673when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10674usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010675future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010676
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010677ssl_bc : boolean
10678 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10679 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10680 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10681
10682ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10683 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10684 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10685
10686ssl_bc_cipher : string
10687 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10688 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10689
10690ssl_bc_protocol : string
10691 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10692 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10693
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010694ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010695 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010696 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10697 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010698
10699ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10700 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10701 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10702 if session was reused or not.
10703
10704ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10705 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10706 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010708ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10709 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10710 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10711 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10712 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10713 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010715ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10716 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10717 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10718 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10719 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721ssl_c_err : integer
10722 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10723 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10724 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10725 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10726 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10730 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10731 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10732 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10733 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10734 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10735 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10736 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738ssl_c_key_alg : string
10739 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10740 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10741 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743ssl_c_notafter : string
10744 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10745 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10746 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010748ssl_c_notbefore : string
10749 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10750 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10751 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10755 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10756 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10757 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10758 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10759 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10760 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10761 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763ssl_c_serial : binary
10764 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10765 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10766 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010768ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10769 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10770 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10771 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10774 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10775 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10776 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778ssl_c_used : boolean
10779 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10780 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010782ssl_c_verify : integer
10783 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10784 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10785 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10786 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788ssl_c_version : integer
10789 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10790 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010792ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10793 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10794 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10795 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10796 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010797 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010798 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10799 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10800 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802ssl_f_key_alg : string
10803 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10804 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10805 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807ssl_f_notafter : string
10808 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10809 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10810 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812ssl_f_notbefore : string
10813 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10814 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10815 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010817ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10818 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10819 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10820 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10821 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10822 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10823 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10824 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10825 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010827ssl_f_serial : binary
10828 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10829 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10830 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010831
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010832ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10833 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10834 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10835 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010837ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10838 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10839 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10840 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842ssl_f_version : integer
10843 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10844 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10845
10846ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010847 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10848 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10849 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851 Example :
10852 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10853 listen http-https
10854 bind :80
10855 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10856 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10857
10858ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10859 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10860 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10861
10862ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010863 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010864 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10865 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10866 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10867 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10868 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10869 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10870 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10871 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010873ssl_fc_cipher : string
10874 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10875 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010877ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010878 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10879 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010880 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10881 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10882 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10883 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010885ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10886 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010887 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10888 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10889 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10890 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010892ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010893 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010894 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10895 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10896 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10897 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10898 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10899 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10900 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902ssl_fc_protocol : string
10903 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10904 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010905
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010906ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010907 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010908 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10909 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10912 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10913 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10914 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10915 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917ssl_fc_sni : string
10918 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10919 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10920 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10921 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10922 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10923
10924 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10925 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10926 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010927 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10928 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010931 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10932 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010934ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10935 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10936 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010937
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010938
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109397.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010942Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10943sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10944only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10945For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10946be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10947can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10948sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10949for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10950content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010952payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10953 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10954 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10955 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010957payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10958 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10959 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10960 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962req.len : integer
10963req_len : integer (deprecated)
10964 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10965 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10966 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10967 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10968 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10969 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10970 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10971 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10974 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010975 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10976 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10977 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10978 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980 ACL alternatives :
10981 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010983req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10984 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10985 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10986 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10987 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010989 ACL alternatives :
10990 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010992 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994req.proto_http : boolean
10995req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10996 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10997 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10998 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10999 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11000 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11001 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11002 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004 Example:
11005 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11006 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11007 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011008 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11011rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11012 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11013 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11014 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11015 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11016 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11017 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11018 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011020 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11021 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11022 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11023 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11024 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11025 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011027 ACL derivatives :
11028 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030 Example :
11031 listen tse-farm
11032 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11033 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11034 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11035 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11036 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11037 persist rdp-cookie
11038 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11039 # This is only useful makes sense if
11040 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11041 stick-table type string size 204800
11042 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11043 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11044 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011046 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11047 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011049req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11050rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11051 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11052 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11053 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11054 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 ACL derivatives :
11057 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11060req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11061 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11062 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11063 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11064 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11065 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11066 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11067 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069req.ssl_sni : string
11070req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11071 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11072 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11073 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11074 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11075 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11076 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11077 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11078 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11079 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11080 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11081 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11082 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 ACL derivatives :
11085 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011087 Examples :
11088 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11089 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11090 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11091 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11092 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11095rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11096 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11097 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11098 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11099 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11100 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11101 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11102 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011104req.ssl_ver : integer
11105req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11106 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11107 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11108 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11109 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11110 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11111 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11112 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11113 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11114 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011116 ACL derivatives :
11117 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011118
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011119res.len : integer
11120 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11121 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11122 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11123 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11124 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11125 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11126 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11127 content inspection.
11128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011129res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11130 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011131 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11132 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11133 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11134 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011136res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11137 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11138 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11139 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11140 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011142 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144wait_end : boolean
11145 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11146 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11147 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11148 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11149 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11150 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11151 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11152 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011154 Examples :
11155 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11156 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11157 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011159 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11160 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11161 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11162 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11163 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11164 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11165 tcp-request content reject
11166
11167
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111687.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011169--------------------------------------
11170
11171It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11172This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11173data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11174its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11175HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11176content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11177to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11178more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11179response are indexed.
11180
11181base : string
11182 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11183 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11184 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11185 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11186 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11187 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11188 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11189 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11190
11191 ACL derivatives :
11192 base : exact string match
11193 base_beg : prefix match
11194 base_dir : subdir match
11195 base_dom : domain match
11196 base_end : suffix match
11197 base_len : length match
11198 base_reg : regex match
11199 base_sub : substring match
11200
11201base32 : integer
11202 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11203 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11204 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11205 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11206
11207base32+src : binary
11208 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11209 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11210 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11211 per-URL counters.
11212
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011213capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11214 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11215 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11216 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11217
11218capture.req.method : string
11219 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11220 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11221 because it's allocated.
11222
11223capture.req.uri : string
11224 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11225 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11226 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11227 allocated.
11228
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011229capture.req.ver : string
11230 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11231 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11232 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11233
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011234capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11235 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11236 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11237 The first entry is an index of 0.
11238 See also: "capture response header"
11239
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011240capture.res.ver : string
11241 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11242 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11243 persistent flag.
11244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011245req.cook([<name>]) : string
11246cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11247 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11248 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11249 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11250 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11251 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11252 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11253 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11254 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11255
11256 ACL derivatives :
11257 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11258 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11259 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11260 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11261 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11262 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11263 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11264 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011266req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11267cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11268 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11269 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11272cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11273 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11274 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11275 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11276 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011278cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11279 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11280 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11281 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11282 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11283 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11284 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11285 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11286 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11287 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11288 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011290hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11291 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11292 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11293 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11294 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011295 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011297req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11298 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11299 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11300 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11301 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11302 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11303 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11304 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11305 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011307req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11308 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11309 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11310 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11311 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011313req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11314 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11315 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11316 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11317 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11318 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11319 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11320 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11321 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11322 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11323 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11324 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 ACL derivatives :
11327 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11328 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11329 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11330 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11331 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11332 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11333 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11334 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11335
11336req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11337hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11338 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11339 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11340 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11341 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11342 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11343 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11344 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11345 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11346 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11347
11348req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11349hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11350 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11351 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11352 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11353 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11354 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11355 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11356 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11357 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11358
11359req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11360hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11361 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11362 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11363 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11364 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11365 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11366 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11367 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11368
11369http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11370 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11371 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11372 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11373 basic auth is supported.
11374
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011375http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11376 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11377 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11378 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11379 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011380 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11381 basic auth is supported.
11382
11383 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011384 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11385 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11386 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11387 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388
11389http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011390 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11391 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11393 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011395method : integer + string
11396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11397 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11398 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11399 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11400 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11401 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11402 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404 ACL derivatives :
11405 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011407 Example :
11408 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11409 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11410 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412path : string
11413 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11414 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11415 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11416 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11417 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11418 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11419 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421 ACL derivatives :
11422 path : exact string match
11423 path_beg : prefix match
11424 path_dir : subdir match
11425 path_dom : domain match
11426 path_end : suffix match
11427 path_len : length match
11428 path_reg : regex match
11429 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011431req.ver : string
11432req_ver : string (deprecated)
11433 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11434 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11435 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011437 ACL derivatives :
11438 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440res.comp : boolean
11441 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11442 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11443 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445res.comp_algo : string
11446 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11447 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11448 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450res.cook([<name>]) : string
11451scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11452 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11453 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11454 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011456 ACL derivatives :
11457 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011459res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11460scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11461 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11462 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11463 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11466scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11467 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11468 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11469 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11472 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11473 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11474 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11475 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11476 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11477 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11478 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11479 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11480 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011482res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11483 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11484 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11485 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11486 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11487 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011489res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11490shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11491 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11492 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11493 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11494 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11495 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11496 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11497 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11498 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011500 ACL derivatives :
11501 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11502 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11503 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11504 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11505 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11506 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11507 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11508 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11509
11510res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11511shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11512 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11513 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11514 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11515 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11516 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011518res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11519shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11520 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11521 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11522 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11523 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11524 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11525 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11528shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11529 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11530 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11531 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11532 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11533 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11534 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536res.ver : string
11537resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11538 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11539 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011541 ACL derivatives :
11542 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011544set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11545 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11546 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11547 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11548 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011550 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11551 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011553 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011555status : integer
11556 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11557 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11558 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560url : string
11561 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11562 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11563 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11564 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11565 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11566 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11567 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011569 ACL derivatives :
11570 url : exact string match
11571 url_beg : prefix match
11572 url_dir : subdir match
11573 url_dom : domain match
11574 url_end : suffix match
11575 url_len : length match
11576 url_reg : regex match
11577 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011579url_ip : ip
11580 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11581 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11582 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11583 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11584 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11585 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11586 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011588url_port : integer
11589 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11590 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11591 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11592 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11595url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11596 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11597 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11598 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11599 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11600 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11601 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11602 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11603 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11604 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011606 ACL derivatives :
11607 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11608 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11609 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11610 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11611 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11612 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11613 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11614 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011615
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617 Example :
11618 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11619 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11620 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11621 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011623urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11624 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11625 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11626 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011627
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116297.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011630---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011632Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11633every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011634order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011636ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11637---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011638FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011639HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011640HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11641HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011642HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11643HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11644HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11645HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11646LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011647METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11648METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11649METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11650METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11651METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11652METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011653RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011654REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011655TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011656WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11657---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011658
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116608. Logging
11661----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011662
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011663One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11664provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11665very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11666provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11667state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011668to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011669headers.
11670
11671In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11672about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11673send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11674
11675 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11676 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11677 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11678 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11679 at the termination.
11680
11681The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11682allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11683as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11684while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11685real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11686delay.
11687
11688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116898.1. Log levels
11690---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011691
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011692TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011693source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011694HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11695in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11696track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11697syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11698about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011699
11700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117018.2. Log formats
11702----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011703
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011704HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011705and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11706slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11707options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011708
11709 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11710 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11711 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11712 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11713 extents.
11714
11715 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11716 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11717 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11718 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11719 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11720
11721 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11722 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11723 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11724 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11725 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11726
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011727 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11728 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11729 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11730 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11731
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011732 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011734Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11735specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11736field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11737servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11738always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11739identifier.
11740
11741Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11742 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11743 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11744 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11745 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11746
11747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117488.2.1. Default log format
11749-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011750
11751This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11752as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11753format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11754
11755 Example :
11756 listen www
11757 mode http
11758 log global
11759 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11760
11761 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11762 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11763 (www/HTTP)
11764
11765 Field Format Extract from the example above
11766 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11767 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11768 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11769 4 'to' to
11770 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11771 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11772
11773Detailed fields description :
11774 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11775 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11776 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11777 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11778 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11779 and processed the connection.
11780 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11781
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011782In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11783"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11784connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11785
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011786It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11787will eventually disappear.
11788
11789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117908.2.2. TCP log format
11791---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011792
11793The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11794is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11795information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11796counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11797emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11798environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11799the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11800sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011801specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11802not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11803fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11804marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011805
11806 Example :
11807 frontend fnt
11808 mode tcp
11809 option tcplog
11810 log global
11811 default_backend bck
11812
11813 backend bck
11814 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11815
11816 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11817 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11818 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11819
11820 Field Format Extract from the example above
11821 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11822 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11823 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11824 4 frontend_name fnt
11825 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11826 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11827 7 bytes_read* 212
11828 8 termination_state --
11829 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11830 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11831
11832Detailed fields description :
11833 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011834 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11835 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11836 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11837 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11838 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011839
11840 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011841 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11842 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11843 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011844
11845 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11846 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11847 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11848 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11849
11850 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11851 and processed the connection.
11852
11853 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11854 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11855 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11856 applications.
11857
11858 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11859 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11860 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11861 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11862 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11863
11864 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11865 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11866 See "Timers" below for more details.
11867
11868 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11869 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11870 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11871 "Timers" below for more details.
11872
11873 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011874 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011875 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11876 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11877 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11878 details.
11879
11880 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11881 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11882 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11883 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11884 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11885
11886 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11887 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11888 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11889 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11890 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11891 for more details.
11892
11893 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011894 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011895 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11896 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11897 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011898 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011899
11900 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11901 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11902 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11903 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11904 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11905 caused by a denial of service attack.
11906
11907 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11908 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11909 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11910 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11911 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11912 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11913 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11914 denial of service attack.
11915
11916 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11917 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11918 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11919 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11920 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11921 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11922 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11923 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11924 be processed than on other servers.
11925
11926 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11927 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11928 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11929 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11930 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11931 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11932 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11933 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11934 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11935 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11936 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11937 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11938 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11939
11940 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11941 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11942 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11943 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11944 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11945 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11946 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11947 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11948
11949 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11950 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11951 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11952 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11953 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11954 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11955 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11956 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11957 occurs.
11958
11959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119608.2.3. HTTP log format
11961----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011962
11963The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11964is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11965the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11966are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11967emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11968generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11969"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11970which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011971frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11972is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011973
11974Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11975slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11976with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11977
11978 Example :
11979 frontend http-in
11980 mode http
11981 option httplog
11982 log global
11983 default_backend bck
11984
11985 backend static
11986 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11987
11988 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11989 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11990 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011991 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011992
11993 Field Format Extract from the example above
11994 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11995 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11996 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11997 4 frontend_name http-in
11998 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11999 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12000 7 status_code 200
12001 8 bytes_read* 2750
12002 9 captured_request_cookie -
12003 10 captured_response_cookie -
12004 11 termination_state ----
12005 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12006 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12007 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12008 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12009 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012010
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012011
12012Detailed fields description :
12013 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012014 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12015 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12016 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12017 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12018 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012019
12020 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012021 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12022 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12023 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012024
12025 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12026 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12027 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12028 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12029 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12030
12031 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12032 and processed the connection.
12033
12034 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12035 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12036 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12037
12038 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12039 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12040 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12041 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12042 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12043 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12044
12045 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12046 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12047 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12048 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12049 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12050 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12051
12052 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12053 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12054 See "Timers" below for more details.
12055
12056 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12057 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12058 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12059 below for more details.
12060
12061 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12062 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12063 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12064 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12065 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12066 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12067 for more details.
12068
12069 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012070 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012071 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12072 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12073 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12074 details.
12075
12076 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12077 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12078 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12079
12080 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12081 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12082 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12083 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12084 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12085 overflowing.
12086
12087 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12088 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12089 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12090 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12091 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12092 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12093 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12094 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12095
12096 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12097 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12098 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12099 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12100 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12101 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12102 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12103 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12104
12105 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12106 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12107 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12108 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12109 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12110 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12111 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12112
12113 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012114 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012115 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12116 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12117 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012118 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012119 system.
12120
12121 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12122 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12123 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12124 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12125 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12126 caused by a denial of service attack.
12127
12128 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12129 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12130 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12131 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12132 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12133 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12134 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12135 denial of service attack.
12136
12137 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12138 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12139 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12140 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12141 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12142 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12143 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12144 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12145 processed than on other servers.
12146
12147 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12148 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12149 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12150 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12151 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12152 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12153 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12154 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12155 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12156 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12157 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12158 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12159 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12160
12161 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12162 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12163 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12164 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12165 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12166 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12167 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12168 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12169
12170 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12171 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12172 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12173 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12174 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12175 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12176 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12177 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12178 occurs.
12179
12180 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12181 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12182 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12183 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12184 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12185 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12186 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12187 cookies" below for more details.
12188
12189 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12190 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12191 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12192 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12193 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12194 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12195 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12196 and cookies" below for more details.
12197
12198 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12199 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12200 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12201 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12202 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12203 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12204 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12205 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12206
12207
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122088.2.4. Custom log format
12209------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012210
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012211The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012212mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012213
12214HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12215Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12216separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12217prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12218
12219Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12220variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12221string formats ("Q").
12222
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012223If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012224as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012225less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12226the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12227
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012228Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012229In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012230in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012231
12232Flags are :
12233 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012234 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012235
12236 Example:
12237
12238 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12239 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12240
12241At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12242
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012243 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12244 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012245
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012246the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012247
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012248 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012249 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012250 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012251
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012252and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12253
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012254 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012255 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12256
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012257Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12258
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012259 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012260 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012261 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12262 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12263 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012264 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12265 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12266 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012267 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012268 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012269 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012270 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012271 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012272 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012273 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12274 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012275 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012276 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12277 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012278 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012279 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12280 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012281 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12282 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12283 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012284 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012285 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12286 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012287 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012288 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12289 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12290 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012291 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012292 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12293 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12294 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12295 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012296 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012297 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012298 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012299 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012300 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012301 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012302 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12303 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12304 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012305 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012306 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12307 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012308 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012309 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012310 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012311 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012312
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012313 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012314
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012315
123168.2.5. Error log format
12317-----------------------
12318
12319When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12320protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12321By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12322"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12323will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12324logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12325
12326The format looks like this :
12327
12328 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12329 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12330 Connection error during SSL handshake
12331
12332 Field Format Extract from the example above
12333 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12334 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12335 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12336 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12337 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12338
12339These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12340failures.
12341
12342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123438.3. Advanced logging options
12344-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012345
12346Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12347just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12348options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12349for more information about their usage.
12350
12351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123528.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12353------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012354
12355It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12356haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12357commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12358monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12359ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12360
12361 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12362 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12363 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12364 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12365
12366 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12367 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12368 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012369 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012370 such as other load-balancers.
12371
12372 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12373 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12374 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12375
12376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123778.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12378----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012379
12380The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12381what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12382or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12383"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12384just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12385log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12386after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12387is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12388with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12389with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12390
12391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123928.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12393------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012394
12395Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12396for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12397"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12398retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12399raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12400a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12401file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12402you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12403"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12404
12405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12407--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012408
12409Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12410multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12411them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12412"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12413logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12414error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12415and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12416too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12417useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12418alternative.
12419
12420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124218.4. Timing events
12422------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012423
12424Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12425reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12426the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12427frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12428mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12429
12430 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12431 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12432 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12433 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12434 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12435
12436 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12437 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12438 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12439 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12440 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12441
12442 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12443 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12444 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12445 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12446 connection never established.
12447
12448 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12449 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12450 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12451 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12452 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12453 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12454 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12455 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12456 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12457 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12458 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12459
12460 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12461 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12462 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12463 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012464 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012465
12466 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12467
12468 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12469 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12470 negative.
12471
12472These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12473protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12474that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012475due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012476close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12477session has been aborted on timeout.
12478
12479Most common cases :
12480
12481 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12482 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12483 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12484 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12485 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12486 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12487 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12488 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12489 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012490 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12491 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12492 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012493
12494 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12495 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12496 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12497 of ms on remote networks.
12498
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012499 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12500 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12501 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012502
12503 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12504 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12505 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12506 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12507 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12508 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12509 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12510 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12511 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12512 to the server until another one is released.
12513
12514Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12515
12516 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12517 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12518 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12519
12520 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12521 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12522 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12523
12524 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12525 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12526 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12527 flags.
12528
12529 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12530 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12531 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12532 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12533 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12534 the client connection was maintained open.
12535
12536 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012537 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012538 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12539 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12540
12541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125428.5. Session state at disconnection
12543-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012544
12545TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12546"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125472-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12548each of which has a special meaning :
12549
12550 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12551 session to terminate :
12552
12553 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12554
12555 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12556 server explicitly refused it.
12557
12558 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12559 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12560 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12561 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012562 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12563
12564 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12565 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012566
12567 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12568 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12569 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12570 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12571 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12572
12573 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12574 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12575 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12576 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12577 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12578
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012579 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12580 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12581
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012582 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12583 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12584 backup connections when going up.
12585
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012586 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12587
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012588 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12589 send or receive data.
12590
12591 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12592 send or receive data.
12593
12594 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12595 with nothing left in the buffers.
12596
12597 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12598
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012599 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012600 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12601
12602 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12603 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12604 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12605 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12606 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12607
12608 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12609 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12610
12611 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12612 server (HTTP only).
12613
12614 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12615
12616 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12617 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12618 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12619
12620 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12621 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12622 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12623
12624 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12625
12626 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12627 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12628
12629 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12630 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12631 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12632
12633 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12634 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012635 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12636 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012637
12638 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12639 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12640 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12641 another server.
12642
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012643 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012644 server.
12645
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012646 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12647 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12648 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12649 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12650
12651 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12652 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12653 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12654 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12655
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012656 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12657 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12658 "use-server" rule).
12659
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012660 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12661
12662 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12663 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12664
12665 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12666
12667 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12668 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12669 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12670
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012671 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12672 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012673 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012674 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12675 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12676
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012677 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12678
12679 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12680 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12681
12682 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12683
12684 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12685
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012686The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12687was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012688helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12689starvation, attacks, etc...
12690
12691The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12692alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12693easier finding and understanding.
12694
12695 Flags Reason
12696
12697 -- Normal termination.
12698
12699 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12700 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12701 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12702 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12703
12704 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12705 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12706 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12707 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12708 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12709 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012711 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12712 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012713 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012714
12715 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12716 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12717 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12718
12719 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12720 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12721 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12722 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12723 the server takes too long to respond.
12724
12725 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12726 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12727 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12728 long a time to respond.
12729
12730 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12731 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12732 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12733 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12734 and the client.
12735
12736 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12737 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12738 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12739 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12740 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012741 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12742 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12743 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12744 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12745 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12746 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12747 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12748 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12749 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12750 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12751 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12752 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12753 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12754 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012755
12756 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12757 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012758 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12759 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12760 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12761 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012762
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012763 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12764 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012766 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012767 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12768 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12769 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12770 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12771 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12772
12773 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12774 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12775 503 or 504 here.
12776
12777 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12778 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12779 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12780 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12781 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12782
12783 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12784 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012785 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012786 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12787 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12788
12789 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12790 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12791 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12792 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12793 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12794 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12795 between haproxy and the server.
12796
12797 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12798 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12799 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12800 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12801 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12802 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12803 solution is to fix the application.
12804
12805 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12806 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12807 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12808 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12809 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12810 external attacks.
12811
12812 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12813 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012814 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012815 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12816 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12817
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012818 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12819 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12820 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012821 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12822 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012823
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012824 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12825 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12826 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12827 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012828 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12829 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12830 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12831 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12832 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012833
12834 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12835 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12836 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12837 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12838
12839 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12840 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12841 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12842 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12843
12844 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12845 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12846 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12847 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12848
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012849The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12850persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12851important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12852re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12853
12854 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12855
12856 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12857 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12858 set on a GET request.
12859
12860 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12861 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012862 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012863 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12864
12865 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12866 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12867 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12868
12869 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12870 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12871 already got a cookie.
12872
12873 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12874 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12875 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12876 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12877 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12878
12879 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12880 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12881 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12882
12883 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12884 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12885 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12886
12887 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12888 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12889
12890 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12891 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12892 then advertised in the response.
12893
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128958.6. Non-printable characters
12896-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012897
12898In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12899consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12900converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12901prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12902being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12903escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12904is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12905'}' when logging headers.
12906
12907Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12908issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12909containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12910
12911Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12912the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12913performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12914
12915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129168.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12917---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012918
12919Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12920achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012921section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012922cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12923the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12924the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012926not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12927user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12928a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12929wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12930
12931 Examples :
12932 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12933 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12934
12935 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12936 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12937
12938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129398.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12940---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012941
12942Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12943proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12944the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12945server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12946
12947Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12948response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012949section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012950
12951It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012952time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12953appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012954are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12955and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12956follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12957request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12958in the logs.
12959
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012960As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12961frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12962an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12963
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012964 Example :
12965 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12966 listen proxy-out
12967 mode http
12968 option httplog
12969 option logasap
12970 log global
12971 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12972
12973 # log the name of the virtual server
12974 capture request header Host len 20
12975
12976 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12977 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12978
12979 # log the beginning of the referrer
12980 capture request header Referer len 20
12981
12982 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12983 capture response header Server len 20
12984
12985 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12986 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12987
12988 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12989 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12990
12991 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12992 capture response header Via len 20
12993
12994 # log the URL location during a redirection
12995 capture response header Location len 20
12996
12997 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12998 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12999 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13000 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13001 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13002
13003 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13004 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13005 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13006 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013007 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013008
13009 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13010 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13011 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13012 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13013 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013014 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013015
13016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130178.9. Examples of logs
13018---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013019
13020These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13021them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13022reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13023
13024 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13025 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13026 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13027
13028 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13029 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13030
13031 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13032 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13033 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13034
13035 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13036 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13037
13038 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13039 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13040 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13041
13042 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013043 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013044 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13045 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13046
13047 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13048 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13049 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13050
13051 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13052 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013053 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013054 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13055 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13056 to return the 502 and not the server.
13057
13058 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013059 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013060
13061 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13062 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13063 Nothing was sent to any server.
13064
13065 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13066 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13067
13068 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13069 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13070 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13071 send a 408 return code to the client.
13072
13073 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13074 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13075
13076 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13077 5 seconds ("c----").
13078
13079 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13080 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013081 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013082
13083 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013084 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013085 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13086 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13087 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13088 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13089 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013090
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130929. Statistics and monitoring
13093----------------------------
13094
13095It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13096mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13097CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13098Unix socket.
13099
13100
131019.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013102---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013103
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013104The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013105page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13106begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13107represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13108use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13109('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13110(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13111text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13112do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13113use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013115 0. pxname: proxy name
13116 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
13117 for server)
13118 2. qcur: current queued requests
13119 3. qmax: max queued requests
13120 4. scur: current sessions
13121 5. smax: max sessions
13122 6. slim: sessions limit
13123 7. stot: total sessions
13124 8. bin: bytes in
13125 9. bout: bytes out
13126 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013127 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013128 12. ereq: request errors
13129 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013130 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013131 15. wretr: retries (warning)
13132 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010013133 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013134 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13135 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13136 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13137 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
13138 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
13139 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
13140 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
13141 25. qlimit: queue limit
13142 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13143 27. iid: unique proxy id
13144 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
13145 29. throttle: warm up status
13146 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
13147 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020013148 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020013149 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13150 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
13151 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013152 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013153 UNK -> unknown
13154 INI -> initializing
13155 SOCKERR -> socket error
13156 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13157 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13158 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13159 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13160 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13161 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13162 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13163 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13164 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13165 disable-on-404
13166 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13167 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13168 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013169 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
13170 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013171 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
13172 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
13173 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
13174 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
13175 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
13176 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013177 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
13178 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13179 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13180 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013181 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13182 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010013183 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13184 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13185 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013186 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013187 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreaua28df3e2014-06-16 16:40:14 +020013188 56. last_chk: last health check contents or textual error
13189 57. last_agt: last agent check contents or textual error
Willy Tarreauf5b1cc32014-06-17 12:20:59 +020013190 58. qtime: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13191 59. ctime: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13192 60. rtime: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests (0 for TCP)
13193 61. ttime: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013194
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131969.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013197-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013198
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013199The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13200necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13201A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13202issuing commands by hand :
13203
13204 global
13205 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13206 stats timeout 2m
13207
13208It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13209the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13210never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13211situations :
13212
13213 global
13214 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13215 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13216 stats timeout 2m
13217
13218To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13219swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13220to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13221syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13222
13223 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13224 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13225
13226The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13227script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13228for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13229
13230The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13231that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13232editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13233(eg: watch a counter).
13234
13235The socket supports two operation modes :
13236 - interactive
13237 - non-interactive
13238
13239The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13240this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13241sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13242mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13243commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13244example :
13245
13246 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13247
13248The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13249entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13250for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13251sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13252"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13253after processing the last command of the same line.
13254
13255For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13256"prompt" command :
13257
13258 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13259 prompt
13260 > show info
13261 ...
13262 >
13263
13264Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13265delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13266that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13267parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013268
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013269It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13270on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13271own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013272
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013273The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13274If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13275all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13276it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13277
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013278add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013279 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13280 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13281 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13282 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013283
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013284add map <map> <key> <value>
13285 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13286 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013287 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13288 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13289 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013290
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013291clear counters
13292 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13293 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13294 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13295 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13296 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13297
13298clear counters all
13299 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13300 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13301 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13302
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013303clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013304 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13305 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13306 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013307
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013308clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013309 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13310 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13311 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013312
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013313clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13314 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13315
13316 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13317 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13318 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13319 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13320 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13321 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13322
13323 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13324
13325 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13326 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13327 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13328 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13329 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13330 the ACLs :
13331
13332 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13333 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13334 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13335 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13336 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13337 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13338
13339 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013340 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13341 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013342
13343 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013344 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013345 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013346 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13347 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13348 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13349 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013350
13351 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13352
13353 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013354 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013355 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13356 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013357 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13358 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13359 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013360
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013361del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13362 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013363 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13364 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13365 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13366 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013367
13368del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013369 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013370 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13371 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13372 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13373 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013374
13375disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013376 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13377
13378 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13379 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13380 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13381 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13382 re-enabled using enable agent.
13383
13384 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13385 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13386 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13387 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13388 otherwise unchanged.
13389
13390 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13391 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13392 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13393
13394 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13395 level "admin".
13396
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013397disable frontend <frontend>
13398 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13399 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13400 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13401 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13402 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13403 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13404 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13405 on the stats page.
13406
13407 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13408 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13409
13410 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13411 level "admin".
13412
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013413disable health <backend>/<server>
13414 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13415 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13416 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13417 agent check forces it down.
13418
13419 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13420 level "admin".
13421
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013422disable server <backend>/<server>
13423 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13424 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13425 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13426 during the maintenance.
13427
13428 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13429 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13430
13431 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013432 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013433
13434 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13435 level "admin".
13436
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013437enable agent <backend>/<server>
13438 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13439
13440 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13441 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13442
13443 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13444 level "admin".
13445
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013446enable frontend <frontend>
13447 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13448 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13449 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13450 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13451 which was disabled.
13452
13453 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13454 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13455
13456 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13457 level "admin".
13458
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013459enable health <backend>/<server>
13460 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13461 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13462
13463 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13464 level "admin".
13465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013466enable server <backend>/<server>
13467 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13468 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13469
13470 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013471 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013472
13473 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13474 level "admin".
13475
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013476get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013477get acl <acl> <value>
13478 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13479 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13480 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13481 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13482 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013483
13484 The first two words are:
13485
13486 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13487 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13488 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13489
13490 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13491
13492 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13493
13494 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13495
13496 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13497 interpretation of the case.
13498
13499 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13500 useful with regular expressions.
13501
13502 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13503 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13504
13505 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13506 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13507 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13508
13509 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13510
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013511get weight <backend>/<server>
13512 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13513 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13514 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13515 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13516 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013517 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013518
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013519help
13520 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13521 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013522
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013523prompt
13524 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13525 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13526 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13527 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13528 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13529 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13530 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13531 command.
13532
13533quit
13534 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013535
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013536set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013537 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13538 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13539 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013540
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013541set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013542 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13543 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13544 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13545 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13546 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013547 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13548 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13549
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013550set maxconn global <maxconn>
13551 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13552 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13553 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13554 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13555 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13556 setting.
13557
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013558set rate-limit connections global <value>
13559 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13560 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13561 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13562 is passed in number of connections per second.
13563
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013564set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13565 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13566 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013567 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13568 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013569
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013570set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13571 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13572 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13573 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13574 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13575
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013576set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13577 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13578 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13579 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13580 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13581 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13582
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013583set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13584 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13585 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13586 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13587
13588set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13589 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13590 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13591 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13592
13593set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13594 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13595 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13596 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13597 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13598 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13599 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13600 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13601 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13602
13603set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13604 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13605 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13606
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013607set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13608 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13609 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13610 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13611 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13612
13613 Example:
13614 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13615 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13616 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13617 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13618
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013619set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013620 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13621 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13622 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13623 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013624 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13625 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013627set timeout cli <delay>
13628 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13629 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13630 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13631
13632set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13633 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13634 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013635 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13636 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13637 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13638 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13639 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13640 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13641 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13642 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13643 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13644 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13645 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13646 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13647 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013648
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013649show errors [<iid>]
13650 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13651 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013652 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13653 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13654 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013655
13656 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13657 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13658 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13659 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13660 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13661 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13662 are reported too.
13663
13664 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13665 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13666 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13667 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13668 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13669 code.
13670
13671 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13672 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13673 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13674 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13675 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13676 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13677 line.
13678
13679 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013680 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13681 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013682 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13683 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13684
13685 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13686 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13687 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13688 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13689 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13690 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13691 00204+ minal\r\n
13692 00211 \r\n
13693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013694 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013695 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13696 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13697 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13698 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13699 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13700 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013701
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013702show info
13703 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13704
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013705show map [<map>]
13706 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013707 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13708 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13709 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13710 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13711 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13712 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013713
13714show acl [<acl>]
13715 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013716 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13717 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13718 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13719 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13720 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013721
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013722show pools
13723 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13724 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13725 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13726 the pools.
13727
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013728show sess
13729 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013730 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13731 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13732
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013733show sess <id>
13734 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13735 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13736 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13737 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13738 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013739 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13740 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13741 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013742
13743show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13744 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13745 possible to dump only selected items :
13746 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13747 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13748 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13749 for example:
13750 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13751 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13752 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13753
13754 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013755 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13756 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013757 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13758 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13759 Nbproc: 1
13760 Process_num: 1
13761 (...)
13762
13763 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13764 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13765 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13766 (...)
13767 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13768
13769 $
13770
13771 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13772 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13773 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13774 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013775 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013776
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013777show table
13778 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13779 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13780 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13781 entries currently in use.
13782
13783 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013784 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013785 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13786 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013787
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013788show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013789 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13790 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13791 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013792 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13793
13794 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13795 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13796 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13797 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13798 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13799
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013800 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13801 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13802 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13803 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13804 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13805 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13806
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013807
13808 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013809 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13810 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013811
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013812 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013813 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013814 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013815 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13816 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13817 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13818 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013819
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013820 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013821 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013822 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13823 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013824
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013825 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13826 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013827 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013828 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13829 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013830
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013831 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13832 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013833 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013834 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13835 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13836
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013837 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13838 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13839 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13840 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13841 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13842
13843 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13844 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13845 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013846 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13847 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013848 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13849 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013850
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013851shutdown frontend <frontend>
13852 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13853 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13854 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13855 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13856 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13857 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13858 once it is terminated.
13859
13860 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13861 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13862
13863 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13864 level "admin".
13865
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013866shutdown session <id>
13867 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13868 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13869 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13870 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13871 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13872 flag in the logs.
13873
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013874shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13875 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13876 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13877 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13878 'K' flag in the logs.
13879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013880/*
13881 * Local variables:
13882 * fill-column: 79
13883 * End:
13884 */